* config/tc-xtensa.c (xg_translate_sysreg_op): Remove has_underbar
[binutils.git] / bfd / elfxx-mips.c
blob98974bde8a85a50b0d207f26fae8e8bc0f801edc
1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2 Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
6 <ian@cygnus.com>.
7 N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
8 <mark@codesourcery.com>
9 Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
10 Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
12 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
14 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
15 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
16 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
17 (at your option) any later version.
19 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
20 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
21 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
22 GNU General Public License for more details.
24 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
25 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
26 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
28 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "sysdep.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "libiberty.h"
34 #include "elf-bfd.h"
35 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
36 #include "elf/mips.h"
38 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */
39 #include "coff/sym.h"
40 #include "coff/symconst.h"
41 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
42 #include "coff/mips.h"
44 #include "hashtab.h"
46 /* This structure is used to hold .got entries while estimating got
47 sizes. */
48 struct mips_got_entry
50 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
51 bfd *abfd;
52 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
53 we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */
54 long symndx;
55 union
57 /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */
58 bfd_vma address;
59 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
60 that should be added to the symbol value. */
61 bfd_vma addend;
62 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
63 corresponding to a global symbol in the got (or, local, if
64 h->forced_local). */
65 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
66 } d;
68 /* The TLS types included in this GOT entry (specifically, GD and
69 IE). The GD and IE flags can be added as we encounter new
70 relocations. LDM can also be set; it will always be alone, not
71 combined with any GD or IE flags. An LDM GOT entry will be
72 a local symbol entry with r_symndx == 0. */
73 unsigned char tls_type;
75 /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
76 corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol
77 whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */
78 long gotidx;
81 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */
83 struct mips_got_info
85 /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
86 symbol table. */
87 struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
88 /* The number of global .got entries. */
89 unsigned int global_gotno;
90 /* The number of .got slots used for TLS. */
91 unsigned int tls_gotno;
92 /* The first unused TLS .got entry. Used only during
93 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
94 unsigned int tls_assigned_gotno;
95 /* The number of local .got entries. */
96 unsigned int local_gotno;
97 /* The number of local .got entries we have used. */
98 unsigned int assigned_gotno;
99 /* A hash table holding members of the got. */
100 struct htab *got_entries;
101 /* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info. NULL
102 unless multi-got was necessary. */
103 struct htab *bfd2got;
104 /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
105 of the time, it points to the previous got). */
106 struct mips_got_info *next;
107 /* This is the GOT index of the TLS LDM entry for the GOT, MINUS_ONE
108 for none, or MINUS_TWO for not yet assigned. This is needed
109 because a single-GOT link may have multiple hash table entries
110 for the LDM. It does not get initialized in multi-GOT mode. */
111 bfd_vma tls_ldm_offset;
114 /* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link. */
116 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash {
117 bfd *bfd;
118 struct mips_got_info *g;
121 /* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to
122 create and merge bfd's gots. */
124 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
126 /* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots. */
127 htab_t bfd2got;
128 /* The output bfd. */
129 bfd *obfd;
130 /* The link information. */
131 struct bfd_link_info *info;
132 /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
133 the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
134 DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */
135 struct mips_got_info *primary;
136 /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
137 gots. */
138 struct mips_got_info *current;
139 /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
140 16-bit offset. */
141 unsigned int max_count;
142 /* The number of local and global entries in the primary got. */
143 unsigned int primary_count;
144 /* The number of local and global entries in the current got. */
145 unsigned int current_count;
146 /* The total number of global entries which will live in the
147 primary got and be automatically relocated. This includes
148 those not referenced by the primary GOT but included in
149 the "master" GOT. */
150 unsigned int global_count;
153 /* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal. */
155 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg
157 struct mips_got_info *g;
158 int value;
159 unsigned int needed_relocs;
160 struct bfd_link_info *info;
163 /* A structure used to count TLS relocations or GOT entries, for GOT
164 entry or ELF symbol table traversal. */
166 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg
168 struct bfd_link_info *info;
169 unsigned int needed;
172 struct _mips_elf_section_data
174 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
175 union
177 struct mips_got_info *got_info;
178 bfd_byte *tdata;
179 } u;
182 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
183 ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
185 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
186 the dynamic symbols. */
188 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
190 /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
191 index. */
192 struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
193 /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a non-TLS
194 symbol with a GOT entry. */
195 long min_got_dynindx;
196 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
197 with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
198 with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */
199 long max_unref_got_dynindx;
200 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a
201 symbol without a GOT entry. */
202 long max_non_got_dynindx;
205 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
206 the global hash table. */
208 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
210 struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
212 /* External symbol information. */
213 EXTR esym;
215 /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
216 this symbol. */
217 unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
219 /* If the R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 reloc is against
220 a readonly section. */
221 bfd_boolean readonly_reloc;
223 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
224 related to taking the function's address, i.e. any but
225 R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones -- see "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition",
226 p. 4-20. */
227 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub;
229 /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
230 16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
231 asection *fn_stub;
233 /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is set if this symbol appears
234 in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */
235 bfd_boolean need_fn_stub;
237 /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
238 32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
239 asection *call_stub;
241 /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
242 being called returns a floating point value. */
243 asection *call_fp_stub;
245 /* Are we forced local? This will only be set if we have converted
246 the initial global GOT entry to a local GOT entry. */
247 bfd_boolean forced_local;
249 #define GOT_NORMAL 0
250 #define GOT_TLS_GD 1
251 #define GOT_TLS_LDM 2
252 #define GOT_TLS_IE 4
253 #define GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE 0x40
254 #define GOT_TLS_DONE 0x80
255 unsigned char tls_type;
256 /* This is only used in single-GOT mode; in multi-GOT mode there
257 is one mips_got_entry per GOT entry, so the offset is stored
258 there. In single-GOT mode there may be many mips_got_entry
259 structures all referring to the same GOT slot. It might be
260 possible to use root.got.offset instead, but that field is
261 overloaded already. */
262 bfd_vma tls_got_offset;
265 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
267 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
269 struct elf_link_hash_table root;
270 #if 0
271 /* We no longer use this. */
272 /* String section indices for the dynamic section symbols. */
273 bfd_size_type dynsym_sec_strindex[SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES];
274 #endif
275 /* The number of .rtproc entries. */
276 bfd_size_type procedure_count;
277 /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */
278 bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
279 /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic
280 entry is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5. */
281 bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
282 /* This is the value of the __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */
283 bfd_vma rld_value;
284 /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */
285 bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
288 #define TLS_RELOC_P(r_type) \
289 (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32 \
290 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 \
291 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32 \
292 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 \
293 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD \
294 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM \
295 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
296 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
297 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
298 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32 \
299 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 \
300 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
301 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16)
303 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */
305 struct extsym_info
307 bfd *abfd;
308 struct bfd_link_info *info;
309 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
310 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
311 bfd_boolean failed;
314 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */
316 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
318 "_procedure_table",
319 "_procedure_string_table",
320 "_procedure_table_size",
321 NULL
324 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
325 IRIX5. */
327 typedef struct
329 unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */
330 unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */
331 unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */
332 unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */
333 unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */
334 unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */
335 } Elf32_compact_rel;
337 typedef struct
339 bfd_byte id1[4];
340 bfd_byte num[4];
341 bfd_byte id2[4];
342 bfd_byte offset[4];
343 bfd_byte reserved0[4];
344 bfd_byte reserved1[4];
345 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
347 typedef struct
349 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
350 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
351 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
352 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
353 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
354 unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */
355 } Elf32_crinfo;
357 typedef struct
359 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
360 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
361 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
362 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
363 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
364 } Elf32_crinfo2;
366 typedef struct
368 bfd_byte info[4];
369 bfd_byte konst[4];
370 bfd_byte vaddr[4];
371 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
373 typedef struct
375 bfd_byte info[4];
376 bfd_byte konst[4];
377 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
379 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */
381 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
382 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
383 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
384 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
385 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
386 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
387 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
388 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
390 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
391 formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
392 fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */
393 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1
394 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0
396 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
397 has different meaning for each type:
399 (type) (konst)
400 CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data
401 CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX)
402 CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr
403 CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump
406 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa
407 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb
408 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc
409 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd
411 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format))
412 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type))
413 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v))
414 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
416 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
417 loader for use by the static exception system. */
419 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
420 bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */
421 long regmask; /* Save register mask. */
422 long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */
423 long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */
424 long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */
425 long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */
426 short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */
427 short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */
428 long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */
429 long reserved;
430 struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */
431 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
432 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
433 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
435 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
436 (bfd *, bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, asection *, bfd_vma, unsigned long,
437 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, int);
438 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
439 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
440 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
441 (bfd_vma);
442 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_stub_section_p
443 (bfd *, asection *);
444 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
445 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
446 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
447 bfd_vma *, asection *);
448 static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash
449 (const void *);
450 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
451 (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
452 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd
453 (struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
455 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */
456 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
458 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */
459 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
460 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
462 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */
463 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
464 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
466 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */
467 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
469 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */
470 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
471 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
473 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */
474 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
475 (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
477 /* The name of the options section. */
478 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
479 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
481 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section.
482 Some IRIX system files do not use MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME. */
483 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
484 (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.options") == 0 || strcmp (NAME, ".options") == 0)
486 /* The name of the stub section. */
487 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
489 /* The size of an external REL relocation. */
490 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
491 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
493 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */
494 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
495 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
497 /* The size of a GOT entry. */
498 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
499 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
501 /* The size of a symbol-table entry. */
502 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
503 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
505 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */
506 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \
507 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
509 /* Get word-sized data. */
510 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
511 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
513 /* Put out word-sized data. */
514 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \
515 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
516 ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \
517 : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
519 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */
520 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
521 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
523 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \
524 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
526 /* Determine whether the internal relocation of index REL_IDX is REL
527 (zero) or RELA (non-zero). The assumption is that, if there are
528 two relocation sections for this section, one of them is REL and
529 the other is RELA. If the index of the relocation we're testing is
530 in range for the first relocation section, check that the external
531 relocation size is that for RELA. It is also assumed that, if
532 rel_idx is not in range for the first section, and this first
533 section contains REL relocs, then the relocation is in the second
534 section, that is RELA. */
535 #define MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P(abfd, sec, rel_idx) \
536 ((NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr) \
537 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel \
538 > (bfd_vma)(rel_idx)) \
539 == (elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr.sh_entsize \
540 == (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela) \
541 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela))))
543 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
544 from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */
545 #define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
546 #define MINUS_TWO (((bfd_vma)0) - 2)
548 /* The number of local .got entries we reserve. */
549 #define MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (2)
551 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */
552 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(abfd) (0x7ff0)
554 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
555 offsets from $gp. */
556 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(abfd) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(abfd) + 0x7fff)
558 /* Instructions which appear in a stub. */
559 #define STUB_LW(abfd) \
560 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
561 ? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
562 : 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
563 #define STUB_MOVE(abfd) \
564 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
565 ? 0x03e0782d /* daddu t7,ra */ \
566 : 0x03e07821)) /* addu t7,ra */
567 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr t9,ra */
568 #define STUB_LI16(abfd) \
569 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
570 ? 0x64180000 /* daddiu t8,zero,0 */ \
571 : 0x24180000)) /* addiu t8,zero,0 */
572 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE (16)
574 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
575 section. */
577 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \
578 (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \
579 : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \
580 : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
582 #ifdef BFD64
583 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
584 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
585 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
586 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
587 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
588 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
589 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
590 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
591 #else
592 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
593 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
594 (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
595 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
596 (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
597 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
598 (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
599 #endif
601 /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
602 floating point arguments.
604 Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
605 copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
606 then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
607 call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit
608 function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to
609 consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
610 if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
611 since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
613 Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
614 that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
615 regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
616 then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
617 to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
618 stub should be discarded.
620 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
621 which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
622 to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while
623 calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
624 must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not
625 needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
626 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
627 $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
629 Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
630 Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation
631 information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
633 We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */
635 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
636 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
637 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
639 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
641 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \
642 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \
643 elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \
644 (copy), (follow)))
646 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
648 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
649 (elf_link_hash_traverse \
650 (&(table)->root, \
651 (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
652 (info)))
654 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
656 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
657 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash))
659 /* Find the base offsets for thread-local storage in this object,
660 for GD/LD and IE/LE respectively. */
662 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
663 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
665 static bfd_vma
666 dtprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
668 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
669 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
670 return 0;
671 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
674 static bfd_vma
675 tprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
677 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
678 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
679 return 0;
680 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
683 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
685 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
686 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
687 struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
689 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
690 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
692 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
693 subclass. */
694 if (ret == NULL)
695 ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
696 if (ret == NULL)
697 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
699 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
700 ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
701 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
702 table, string));
703 if (ret != NULL)
705 /* Set local fields. */
706 memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
707 /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
708 not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */
709 ret->esym.ifd = -2;
710 ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
711 ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
712 ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
713 ret->fn_stub = NULL;
714 ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
715 ret->call_stub = NULL;
716 ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
717 ret->forced_local = FALSE;
718 ret->tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
721 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
724 bfd_boolean
725 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
727 struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
728 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
730 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
731 if (sdata == NULL)
732 return FALSE;
733 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
735 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
738 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
739 ecoff_debug_info structure. */
741 bfd_boolean
742 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
743 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
745 HDRR *symhdr;
746 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
747 char *ext_hdr;
749 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
750 memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
752 ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
753 if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
754 goto error_return;
756 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
757 swap->external_hdr_size))
758 goto error_return;
760 symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
761 (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
763 /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
764 read. */
765 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \
766 if (symhdr->count == 0) \
767 debug->ptr = NULL; \
768 else \
770 bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \
771 debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \
772 if (debug->ptr == NULL) \
773 goto error_return; \
774 if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \
775 || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \
776 goto error_return; \
779 READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
780 READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
781 READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
782 READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
783 READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
784 READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
785 union aux_ext *);
786 READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
787 READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
788 READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
789 READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
790 READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
791 #undef READ
793 debug->fdr = NULL;
795 return TRUE;
797 error_return:
798 if (ext_hdr != NULL)
799 free (ext_hdr);
800 if (debug->line != NULL)
801 free (debug->line);
802 if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
803 free (debug->external_dnr);
804 if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
805 free (debug->external_pdr);
806 if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
807 free (debug->external_sym);
808 if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
809 free (debug->external_opt);
810 if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
811 free (debug->external_aux);
812 if (debug->ss != NULL)
813 free (debug->ss);
814 if (debug->ssext != NULL)
815 free (debug->ssext);
816 if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
817 free (debug->external_fdr);
818 if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
819 free (debug->external_rfd);
820 if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
821 free (debug->external_ext);
822 return FALSE;
825 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */
827 static void
828 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
830 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
831 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
832 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
833 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
834 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
835 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
837 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
838 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
840 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
843 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */
845 static bfd_boolean
846 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
847 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
848 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
850 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
851 HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
852 RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
853 struct rpdr_ext *erp;
854 void *rtproc;
855 struct pdr_ext *epdr;
856 struct sym_ext *esym;
857 char *ss, **sv;
858 char *str;
859 bfd_size_type size;
860 bfd_size_type count;
861 unsigned long sindex;
862 unsigned long i;
863 PDR pdr;
864 SYMR sym;
865 const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
867 epdr = NULL;
868 rpdr = NULL;
869 esym = NULL;
870 ss = NULL;
871 sv = NULL;
873 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
875 sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
876 count = hdr->ipdMax;
877 if (count > 0)
879 size = swap->external_pdr_size;
881 epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
882 if (epdr == NULL)
883 goto error_return;
885 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
886 goto error_return;
888 size = sizeof (RPDR);
889 rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
890 if (rpdr == NULL)
891 goto error_return;
893 size = sizeof (char *);
894 sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
895 if (sv == NULL)
896 goto error_return;
898 count = hdr->isymMax;
899 size = swap->external_sym_size;
900 esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
901 if (esym == NULL)
902 goto error_return;
904 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
905 goto error_return;
907 count = hdr->issMax;
908 ss = bfd_malloc (count);
909 if (ss == NULL)
910 goto error_return;
911 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, (bfd_byte *) ss))
912 goto error_return;
914 count = hdr->ipdMax;
915 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
917 (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
918 (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
919 rp->adr = sym.value;
920 rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
921 rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
922 rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
923 rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
924 rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
925 rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
926 rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
927 rp->irpss = sindex;
928 sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
929 sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
933 size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
934 size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
935 rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
936 if (rtproc == NULL)
938 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
939 goto error_return;
942 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
944 erp = rtproc;
945 memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
946 erp++;
947 str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
948 strcpy (str, no_name_func);
949 str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
950 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
952 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
953 strcpy (str, sv[i]);
954 str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
956 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
958 /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */
959 s->size = size;
960 s->contents = rtproc;
962 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
963 matters, but someday it might). */
964 s->map_head.link_order = NULL;
966 if (epdr != NULL)
967 free (epdr);
968 if (rpdr != NULL)
969 free (rpdr);
970 if (esym != NULL)
971 free (esym);
972 if (ss != NULL)
973 free (ss);
974 if (sv != NULL)
975 free (sv);
977 return TRUE;
979 error_return:
980 if (epdr != NULL)
981 free (epdr);
982 if (rpdr != NULL)
983 free (rpdr);
984 if (esym != NULL)
985 free (esym);
986 if (ss != NULL)
987 free (ss);
988 if (sv != NULL)
989 free (sv);
990 return FALSE;
993 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
994 discard them. */
996 static bfd_boolean
997 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
998 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1000 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1001 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1003 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1004 && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1006 /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1007 are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1008 being included in the link. */
1009 h->fn_stub->size = 0;
1010 h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1011 h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1012 h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1015 if (h->call_stub != NULL
1016 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1018 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1019 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1020 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1021 h->call_stub->size = 0;
1022 h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1023 h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1024 h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1027 if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1028 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1030 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1031 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1032 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1033 h->call_fp_stub->size = 0;
1034 h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1035 h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1036 h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1039 return TRUE;
1042 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
1043 Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
1044 are 32 bits.
1046 The format of these instructions is:
1048 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1049 | JALX | X| Imm 20:16 | Imm 25:21 |
1050 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1051 | Immediate 15:0 |
1052 +-----------------------------------------------+
1054 JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
1055 Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
1057 When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
1058 handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is
1059 stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
1060 (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
1061 R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
1062 always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
1063 16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a
1064 big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
1065 file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
1066 This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
1067 instruction.
1069 When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
1070 instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the
1071 contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as
1072 R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the
1073 immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
1074 value as two 16-bit values.
1076 To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
1077 defined as
1079 big-endian:
1080 +--------+----------------------+
1081 | | |
1082 | | targ26-16 |
1083 |31 26|25 0|
1084 +--------+----------------------+
1086 little-endian:
1087 +----------+------+-------------+
1088 | | | |
1089 | sub1 | | sub2 |
1090 |0 9|10 15|16 31|
1091 +----------+--------------------+
1092 where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
1093 ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
1095 When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
1096 (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1097 When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
1098 let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1099 ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
1101 R_MIPS16_GPREL is used for GP-relative addressing in mips16
1102 mode. A typical instruction will have a format like this:
1104 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1105 | EXTEND | Imm 10:5 | Imm 15:11 |
1106 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1107 | Major | rx | ry | Imm 4:0 |
1108 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1110 EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction
1111 opcode.
1113 This is handled exactly like R_MIPS_GPREL16, except that the
1114 addend is retrieved and stored as shown in this diagram; that
1115 is, the Imm fields above replace the V-rel16 field.
1117 All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately. As
1118 above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
1119 little-endian system.
1121 R_MIPS16_HI16 and R_MIPS16_LO16 are used in mips16 mode to
1122 access data when neither GP-relative nor PC-relative addressing
1123 can be used. They are handled like R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16,
1124 except that the addend is retrieved and stored as shown above
1125 for R_MIPS16_GPREL.
1127 void
1128 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1129 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1131 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1133 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1134 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1135 return;
1137 /* Pick up the mips16 extend instruction and the real instruction. */
1138 extend = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data);
1139 insn = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data + 2);
1140 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1142 if (jal_shuffle)
1143 val = ((extend & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((extend & 0x3e0) << 11)
1144 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 21) | insn;
1145 else
1146 val = extend << 16 | insn;
1148 else
1149 val = ((extend & 0xf800) << 16) | ((insn & 0xffe0) << 11)
1150 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 11) | (extend & 0x7e0) | (insn & 0x1f);
1151 bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, data);
1154 void
1155 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1156 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1158 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1160 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1161 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1162 return;
1164 val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, data);
1165 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1167 if (jal_shuffle)
1169 insn = val & 0xffff;
1170 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
1171 | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
1173 else
1175 insn = val & 0xffff;
1176 extend = val >> 16;
1179 else
1181 insn = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
1182 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
1184 bfd_put_16 (abfd, insn, data + 2);
1185 bfd_put_16 (abfd, extend, data);
1188 bfd_reloc_status_type
1189 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1190 arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
1191 bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
1193 bfd_vma relocation;
1194 bfd_signed_vma val;
1195 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1197 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1198 relocation = 0;
1199 else
1200 relocation = symbol->value;
1202 relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1203 relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
1205 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1206 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1208 /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */
1209 val = reloc_entry->addend;
1211 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
1213 /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we
1214 are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
1215 an external symbol. */
1216 if (! relocatable
1217 || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1218 val += relocation - gp;
1220 if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1222 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1223 (bfd_byte *) data
1224 + reloc_entry->address);
1225 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1226 return status;
1228 else
1229 reloc_entry->addend = val;
1231 if (relocatable)
1232 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1234 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1237 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
1238 R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
1239 that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
1240 INPUT_SECTION. */
1242 struct mips_hi16
1244 struct mips_hi16 *next;
1245 bfd_byte *data;
1246 asection *input_section;
1247 arelent rel;
1250 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */
1252 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
1254 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only
1255 calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
1256 *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
1258 The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
1259 However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
1260 *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly
1261 simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */
1263 bfd_reloc_status_type
1264 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1265 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
1266 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1267 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1269 struct mips_hi16 *n;
1271 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1272 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1274 n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
1275 if (n == NULL)
1276 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1278 n->next = mips_hi16_list;
1279 n->data = data;
1280 n->input_section = input_section;
1281 n->rel = *reloc_entry;
1282 mips_hi16_list = n;
1284 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1285 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1287 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1290 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations. This is just
1291 like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
1292 treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */
1294 bfd_reloc_status_type
1295 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1296 void *data, asection *input_section,
1297 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1299 if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
1300 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
1301 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
1302 /* The relocation is against a global symbol. */
1303 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1304 input_section, output_bfd,
1305 error_message);
1307 return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1308 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1311 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself
1312 is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
1313 any partnering high-part relocations as well. */
1315 bfd_reloc_status_type
1316 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1317 void *data, asection *input_section,
1318 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1320 bfd_vma vallo;
1321 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1323 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1324 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1326 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1327 location);
1328 vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, location);
1329 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1330 location);
1332 while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
1334 bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
1335 struct mips_hi16 *hi;
1337 hi = mips_hi16_list;
1339 /* R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We
1340 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS_HI16
1341 relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16
1342 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
1343 has a rightshift of 0. */
1344 if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
1345 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
1347 /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
1348 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */
1349 hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
1351 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
1352 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
1353 error_message);
1354 if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
1355 return ret;
1357 mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
1358 free (hi);
1361 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1362 input_section, output_bfd,
1363 error_message);
1366 /* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the
1367 relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
1368 bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */
1370 bfd_reloc_status_type
1371 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1372 asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1373 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1374 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1376 bfd_signed_vma val;
1377 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1378 bfd_boolean relocatable;
1380 relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
1382 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1383 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1385 /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */
1386 val = 0;
1387 if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1389 /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
1390 relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's
1391 offset or address. */
1392 val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1393 val += symbol->section->output_offset;
1396 if (!relocatable)
1398 /* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value
1399 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */
1400 val += symbol->value;
1401 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1403 val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
1404 val -= input_section->output_offset;
1405 val -= reloc_entry->address;
1409 /* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation
1410 in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
1411 we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add
1412 VAL to the relocation field itself. */
1413 if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1414 reloc_entry->addend += val;
1415 else
1417 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1419 /* Add in the separate addend, if any. */
1420 val += reloc_entry->addend;
1422 /* Add VAL to the relocation field. */
1423 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1424 location);
1425 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1426 location);
1427 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1428 location);
1430 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1431 return status;
1434 if (relocatable)
1435 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1437 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1440 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely
1441 on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */
1443 static void
1444 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
1445 Elf32_gptab *in)
1447 in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1448 in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1451 static void
1452 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
1453 Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
1455 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1456 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1459 static void
1460 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
1461 Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
1463 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
1464 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
1465 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
1466 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
1467 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
1468 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
1471 static void
1472 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
1473 Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
1475 unsigned long l;
1477 l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
1478 | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
1479 | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
1480 | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
1481 H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
1482 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
1483 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
1486 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These
1487 routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of
1488 BFD, so they are globally visible. */
1490 void
1491 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
1492 Elf32_RegInfo *in)
1494 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1495 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1496 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1497 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1498 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1499 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1502 void
1503 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
1504 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
1506 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1507 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1508 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1509 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1510 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1511 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1514 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
1515 information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap
1516 them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used
1517 outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them
1518 without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */
1520 void
1521 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
1522 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
1524 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1525 in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
1526 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1527 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1528 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1529 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1530 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1533 void
1534 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
1535 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
1537 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1538 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
1539 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1540 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1541 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1542 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1543 H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1546 /* Swap in an options header. */
1548 void
1549 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
1550 Elf_Internal_Options *in)
1552 in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
1553 in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
1554 in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
1555 in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
1558 /* Swap out an options header. */
1560 void
1561 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
1562 Elf_External_Options *ex)
1564 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
1565 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
1566 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
1567 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
1570 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
1571 entries by increasing r_symndx value. */
1573 static int
1574 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
1576 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
1577 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
1579 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
1580 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
1582 return ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
1585 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */
1587 static int
1588 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1589 const void *arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1591 #ifdef BFD64
1592 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
1593 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
1595 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1596 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
1597 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1598 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
1600 return (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info)
1601 - ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info));
1602 #else
1603 abort ();
1604 #endif
1608 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
1609 information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The
1610 ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
1611 symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
1612 whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
1613 tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external
1614 symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
1615 section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
1616 can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
1617 required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
1618 Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
1619 stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen
1620 when generating a final executable. */
1622 static bfd_boolean
1623 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
1625 struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
1626 bfd_boolean strip;
1627 asection *sec, *output_section;
1629 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1630 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1632 if (h->root.indx == -2)
1633 strip = FALSE;
1634 else if ((h->root.def_dynamic
1635 || h->root.ref_dynamic
1636 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
1637 && !h->root.def_regular
1638 && !h->root.ref_regular)
1639 strip = TRUE;
1640 else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
1641 || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
1642 && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
1643 h->root.root.root.string,
1644 FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
1645 strip = TRUE;
1646 else
1647 strip = FALSE;
1649 if (strip)
1650 return TRUE;
1652 if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
1654 h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
1655 h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
1656 h->esym.weakext = 0;
1657 h->esym.reserved = 0;
1658 h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
1659 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1660 h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
1662 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
1663 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
1665 const char *name;
1667 /* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some
1668 special symbols. */
1669 name = h->root.root.root.string;
1670 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
1671 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
1673 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1674 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1675 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1677 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
1679 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1680 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1681 h->esym.asym.value =
1682 mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
1684 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
1686 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1687 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1688 h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
1690 else
1691 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1693 else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
1694 && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1695 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1696 else
1698 const char *name;
1700 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1701 output_section = sec->output_section;
1703 /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
1704 the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */
1705 if (output_section == NULL)
1706 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1707 else
1709 name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
1711 if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
1712 h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
1713 else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
1714 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1715 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
1716 h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
1717 else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
1718 || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
1719 h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
1720 else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
1721 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1722 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
1723 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1724 else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
1725 h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
1726 else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
1727 h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
1728 else
1729 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1733 h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
1734 h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
1737 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
1738 h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
1739 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1740 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1742 if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
1743 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1744 else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
1745 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1747 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1748 output_section = sec->output_section;
1749 if (output_section != NULL)
1750 h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
1751 + sec->output_offset
1752 + output_section->vma);
1753 else
1754 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1756 else if (h->root.needs_plt)
1758 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
1759 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub = h->no_fn_stub;
1761 while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1763 hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
1764 no_fn_stub = no_fn_stub || hd->no_fn_stub;
1767 if (!no_fn_stub)
1769 /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */
1770 h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
1771 sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
1772 if (sec == NULL)
1773 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1774 else
1776 output_section = sec->output_section;
1777 if (output_section != NULL)
1778 h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset
1779 + sec->output_offset
1780 + output_section->vma);
1781 else
1782 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1787 if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
1788 h->root.root.root.string,
1789 &h->esym))
1791 einfo->failed = TRUE;
1792 return FALSE;
1795 return TRUE;
1798 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */
1800 static int
1801 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
1803 const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
1804 const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
1806 return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
1809 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */
1811 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
1812 hash number. */
1814 static INLINE hashval_t
1815 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
1817 #ifdef BFD64
1818 return addr + (addr >> 32);
1819 #else
1820 return addr;
1821 #endif
1824 /* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so
1825 use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate
1826 union members. */
1828 static hashval_t
1829 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
1831 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
1833 return entry->symndx
1834 + ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) << 17)
1835 + (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
1836 : entry->abfd->id
1837 + (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)
1838 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
1841 static int
1842 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
1844 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
1845 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
1847 /* An LDM entry can only match another LDM entry. */
1848 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1849 return 0;
1851 return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx
1852 && (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address
1853 : e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
1854 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
1857 /* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects,
1858 even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the
1859 hash computation and compare functions are adjusted
1860 accordingly. */
1862 static hashval_t
1863 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
1865 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
1867 return entry->symndx
1868 + (! entry->abfd
1869 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
1870 : entry->symndx >= 0
1871 ? ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1872 ? (GOT_TLS_LDM << 17)
1873 : (entry->abfd->id
1874 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)))
1875 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash);
1878 static int
1879 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
1881 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
1882 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
1884 /* Any two LDM entries match. */
1885 if (e1->tls_type & e2->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1886 return 1;
1888 /* Nothing else matches an LDM entry. */
1889 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1890 return 0;
1892 return e1->symndx == e2->symndx
1893 && (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
1894 : e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL
1895 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
1896 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
1899 /* Returns the dynamic relocation section for DYNOBJ. */
1901 static asection *
1902 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (bfd *dynobj, bfd_boolean create_p)
1904 static const char dname[] = ".rel.dyn";
1905 asection *sreloc;
1907 sreloc = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, dname);
1908 if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
1910 sreloc = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, dname,
1911 (SEC_ALLOC
1912 | SEC_LOAD
1913 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
1914 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
1915 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
1916 | SEC_READONLY));
1917 if (sreloc == NULL
1918 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
1919 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
1920 return NULL;
1922 return sreloc;
1925 /* Returns the GOT section for ABFD. */
1927 static asection *
1928 mips_elf_got_section (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)
1930 asection *sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1931 if (sgot == NULL
1932 || (! maybe_excluded && (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0))
1933 return NULL;
1934 return sgot;
1937 /* Returns the GOT information associated with the link indicated by
1938 INFO. If SGOTP is non-NULL, it is filled in with the GOT
1939 section. */
1941 static struct mips_got_info *
1942 mips_elf_got_info (bfd *abfd, asection **sgotp)
1944 asection *sgot;
1945 struct mips_got_info *g;
1947 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
1948 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
1949 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
1950 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
1951 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
1953 if (sgotp)
1954 *sgotp = (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 ? sgot : NULL;
1956 return g;
1959 /* Count the number of relocations needed for a TLS GOT entry, with
1960 access types from TLS_TYPE, and symbol H (or a local symbol if H
1961 is NULL). */
1963 static int
1964 mips_tls_got_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned char tls_type,
1965 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1967 int indx = 0;
1968 int ret = 0;
1969 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
1970 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
1972 if (h && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, h)
1973 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
1974 indx = h->dynindx;
1976 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
1977 && (h == NULL
1978 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
1979 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
1980 need_relocs = TRUE;
1982 if (!need_relocs)
1983 return FALSE;
1985 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
1987 ret++;
1988 if (indx != 0)
1989 ret++;
1992 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
1993 ret++;
1995 if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) && info->shared)
1996 ret++;
1998 return ret;
2001 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the GOT entry in
2002 ARG1, if it describes a local symbol. */
2004 static int
2005 mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs (void **arg1, void *arg2)
2007 struct mips_got_entry *entry = * (struct mips_got_entry **) arg1;
2008 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2010 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx != -1)
2011 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type, NULL);
2013 return 1;
2016 /* Count the number of TLS GOT entries required for the global (or
2017 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2019 static int
2020 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2022 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2023 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2024 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2026 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2027 arg->needed += 2;
2028 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2029 arg->needed += 1;
2031 return 1;
2034 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the global (or
2035 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2037 static int
2038 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2040 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2041 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2042 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2044 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, hm->tls_type, &hm->root);
2046 return 1;
2049 /* Output a simple dynamic relocation into SRELOC. */
2051 static void
2052 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
2053 asection *sreloc,
2054 unsigned long indx,
2055 int r_type,
2056 bfd_vma offset)
2058 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
2060 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
2062 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, indx, r_type);
2063 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
2065 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
2067 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
2068 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2069 (sreloc->contents
2070 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
2072 else
2073 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
2074 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2075 (sreloc->contents
2076 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
2077 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
2080 /* Initialize a set of TLS GOT entries for one symbol. */
2082 static void
2083 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_offset,
2084 unsigned char *tls_type_p,
2085 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2086 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2087 bfd_vma value)
2089 int indx;
2090 asection *sreloc, *sgot;
2091 bfd_vma offset, offset2;
2092 bfd *dynobj;
2093 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2095 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2096 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
2098 indx = 0;
2099 if (h != NULL)
2101 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2103 if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, &h->root)
2104 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
2105 indx = h->root.dynindx;
2108 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_DONE)
2109 return;
2111 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2112 && (h == NULL
2113 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
2114 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2115 need_relocs = TRUE;
2117 /* MINUS_ONE means the symbol is not defined in this object. It may not
2118 be defined at all; assume that the value doesn't matter in that
2119 case. Otherwise complain if we would use the value. */
2120 BFD_ASSERT (value != MINUS_ONE || (indx != 0 && need_relocs)
2121 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak);
2123 /* Emit necessary relocations. */
2124 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
2126 /* General Dynamic. */
2127 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_GD)
2129 offset = got_offset;
2130 offset2 = offset + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2132 if (need_relocs)
2134 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2135 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2136 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2137 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2139 if (indx)
2140 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2141 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2142 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32,
2143 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset2);
2144 else
2145 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2146 sgot->contents + offset2);
2148 else
2150 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2151 sgot->contents + offset);
2152 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2153 sgot->contents + offset2);
2156 got_offset += 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2159 /* Initial Exec model. */
2160 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_IE)
2162 offset = got_offset;
2164 if (need_relocs)
2166 if (indx == 0)
2167 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma,
2168 sgot->contents + offset);
2169 else
2170 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2171 sgot->contents + offset);
2173 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2174 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2175 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32,
2176 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2178 else
2179 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - tprel_base (info),
2180 sgot->contents + offset);
2183 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2185 /* The initial offset is zero, and the LD offsets will include the
2186 bias by DTP_OFFSET. */
2187 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2188 sgot->contents + got_offset
2189 + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2191 if (!info->shared)
2192 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2193 sgot->contents + got_offset);
2194 else
2195 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2196 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2197 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2198 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
2201 *tls_type_p |= GOT_TLS_DONE;
2204 /* Return the GOT index to use for a relocation of type R_TYPE against
2205 a symbol accessed using TLS_TYPE models. The GOT entries for this
2206 symbol in this GOT start at GOT_INDEX. This function initializes the
2207 GOT entries and corresponding relocations. */
2209 static bfd_vma
2210 mips_tls_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_index, unsigned char *tls_type,
2211 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2212 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, bfd_vma symbol)
2214 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
2215 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM);
2217 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (abfd, got_index, tls_type, info, h, symbol);
2219 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL)
2221 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE);
2222 if (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2223 return got_index + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2224 else
2225 return got_index;
2228 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD)
2230 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD);
2231 return got_index;
2234 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2236 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM);
2237 return got_index;
2240 return got_index;
2243 /* Returns the GOT offset at which the indicated address can be found.
2244 If there is not yet a GOT entry for this value, create one. If
2245 R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol, create a TLS GOT entry instead.
2246 Returns -1 if no satisfactory GOT offset can be found. */
2248 static bfd_vma
2249 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2250 bfd_vma value, unsigned long r_symndx,
2251 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
2253 asection *sgot;
2254 struct mips_got_info *g;
2255 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2257 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2259 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot, value,
2260 r_symndx, h, r_type);
2261 if (!entry)
2262 return MINUS_ONE;
2264 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2265 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, entry->gotidx, &entry->tls_type, r_type,
2266 info, h, value);
2267 else
2268 return entry->gotidx;
2271 /* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H. */
2273 static bfd_vma
2274 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2275 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2277 bfd_vma index;
2278 asection *sgot;
2279 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
2280 long global_got_dynindx = 0;
2282 gg = g = mips_elf_got_info (abfd, &sgot);
2283 if (g->bfd2got && ibfd)
2285 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
2287 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0);
2289 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
2290 if (g->next != gg || TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2292 e.abfd = ibfd;
2293 e.symndx = -1;
2294 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
2295 e.tls_type = 0;
2297 p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e);
2299 BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0);
2301 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2303 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2304 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2305 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2306 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2307 value = (h->root.u.def.value
2308 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2309 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2311 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, p->gotidx, &p->tls_type, r_type,
2312 info, e.d.h, value);
2314 else
2315 return p->gotidx;
2319 if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL)
2320 global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
2322 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2324 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2325 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2326 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2328 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2329 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2330 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2331 value = (h->root.u.def.value
2332 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2333 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2335 index = mips_tls_got_index (abfd, hm->tls_got_offset, &hm->tls_type,
2336 r_type, info, hm, value);
2338 else
2340 /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
2341 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
2342 indices into the GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the GOT
2343 offset. */
2344 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
2345 index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
2346 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2348 BFD_ASSERT (index < sgot->size);
2350 return index;
2353 /* Find a GOT entry that is within 32KB of the VALUE. These entries
2354 are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
2355 within 32KB of GP. Return the index into the GOT for this page,
2356 and store the offset from this entry to the desired address in
2357 OFFSETP, if it is non-NULL. */
2359 static bfd_vma
2360 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2361 bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
2363 asection *sgot;
2364 struct mips_got_info *g;
2365 bfd_vma index;
2366 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2368 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2370 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot,
2371 (value + 0x8000)
2372 & (~(bfd_vma)0xffff), 0,
2373 NULL, R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
2375 if (!entry)
2376 return MINUS_ONE;
2378 index = entry->gotidx;
2380 if (offsetp)
2381 *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
2383 return index;
2386 /* Find a GOT entry whose higher-order 16 bits are the same as those
2387 for value. Return the index into the GOT for this entry. */
2389 static bfd_vma
2390 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2391 bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
2393 asection *sgot;
2394 struct mips_got_info *g;
2395 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2397 if (! external)
2399 /* Although the ABI says that it is "the high-order 16 bits" that we
2400 want, it is really the %high value. The complete value is
2401 calculated with a `addiu' of a LO16 relocation, just as with a
2402 HI16/LO16 pair. */
2403 value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
2406 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2408 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, ibfd, g, sgot, value, 0, NULL,
2409 R_MIPS_GOT16);
2410 if (entry)
2411 return entry->gotidx;
2412 else
2413 return MINUS_ONE;
2416 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
2417 in the GOT. */
2419 static bfd_vma
2420 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (bfd *dynobj, bfd *output_bfd,
2421 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma index)
2423 asection *sgot;
2424 bfd_vma gp;
2425 struct mips_got_info *g;
2427 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
2428 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
2429 + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, g, input_bfd);
2431 return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + index - gp;
2434 /* Create a local GOT entry for VALUE. Return the index of the entry,
2435 or -1 if it could not be created. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol,
2436 create a TLS entry instead. */
2438 static struct mips_got_entry *
2439 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd,
2440 struct mips_got_info *gg,
2441 asection *sgot, bfd_vma value,
2442 unsigned long r_symndx,
2443 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2444 int r_type)
2446 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2447 struct mips_got_info *g;
2449 entry.abfd = NULL;
2450 entry.symndx = -1;
2451 entry.d.address = value;
2452 entry.tls_type = 0;
2454 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, ibfd);
2455 if (g == NULL)
2457 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, abfd);
2458 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2461 /* We might have a symbol, H, if it has been forced local. Use the
2462 global entry then. It doesn't matter whether an entry is local
2463 or global for TLS, since the dynamic linker does not
2464 automatically relocate TLS GOT entries. */
2465 BFD_ASSERT (h == NULL || h->root.forced_local);
2466 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2468 struct mips_got_entry *p;
2470 entry.abfd = ibfd;
2471 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2473 entry.tls_type = GOT_TLS_LDM;
2474 entry.symndx = 0;
2475 entry.d.addend = 0;
2477 else if (h == NULL)
2479 entry.symndx = r_symndx;
2480 entry.d.addend = 0;
2482 else
2483 entry.d.h = h;
2485 p = (struct mips_got_entry *)
2486 htab_find (g->got_entries, &entry);
2488 BFD_ASSERT (p);
2489 return p;
2492 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2493 INSERT);
2494 if (*loc)
2495 return *loc;
2497 entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++;
2498 entry.tls_type = 0;
2500 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2502 if (! *loc)
2503 return NULL;
2505 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2507 if (g->assigned_gotno >= g->local_gotno)
2509 (*loc)->gotidx = -1;
2510 /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */
2511 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2512 (_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
2513 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2514 return NULL;
2517 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value,
2518 (sgot->contents + entry.gotidx));
2520 return *loc;
2523 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
2524 appear towards the end. This reduces the amount of GOT space
2525 required. MAX_LOCAL is used to set the number of local symbols
2526 known to be in the dynamic symbol table. During
2527 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections, this value is 1. Afterward, the
2528 section symbols are added and the count is higher. */
2530 static bfd_boolean
2531 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned long max_local)
2533 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
2534 struct mips_got_info *g;
2535 bfd *dynobj;
2537 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2539 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
2541 hsd.low = NULL;
2542 hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx =
2543 hsd.min_got_dynindx = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
2544 /* In the multi-got case, assigned_gotno of the master got_info
2545 indicate the number of entries that aren't referenced in the
2546 primary GOT, but that must have entries because there are
2547 dynamic relocations that reference it. Since they aren't
2548 referenced, we move them to the end of the GOT, so that they
2549 don't prevent other entries that are referenced from getting
2550 too large offsets. */
2551 - (g->next ? g->assigned_gotno : 0);
2552 hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = max_local;
2553 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *)
2554 elf_hash_table (info)),
2555 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f,
2556 &hsd);
2558 /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
2559 accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */
2560 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
2561 BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long)hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
2562 <= elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount);
2564 /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
2565 table index in the GOT. */
2566 g->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
2568 return TRUE;
2571 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
2572 index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
2573 index. */
2575 static bfd_boolean
2576 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2578 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
2580 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2581 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
2583 /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
2584 at all. */
2585 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
2586 return TRUE;
2588 /* Global symbols that need GOT entries that are not explicitly
2589 referenced are marked with got offset 2. Those that are
2590 referenced get a 1, and those that don't need GOT entries get
2591 -1. */
2592 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
2594 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2596 if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
2597 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2598 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
2600 else if (h->root.got.offset != 1)
2601 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
2602 else
2604 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2606 h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
2607 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2610 return TRUE;
2613 /* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic
2614 symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for
2615 posterity. */
2617 static bfd_boolean
2618 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2619 bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2620 struct mips_got_info *g,
2621 unsigned char tls_flag)
2623 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2625 /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
2626 table. */
2627 if (h->dynindx == -1)
2629 switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
2631 case STV_INTERNAL:
2632 case STV_HIDDEN:
2633 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
2634 break;
2636 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
2637 return FALSE;
2640 /* Make sure we have a GOT to put this entry into. */
2641 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2643 entry.abfd = abfd;
2644 entry.symndx = -1;
2645 entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2646 entry.tls_type = 0;
2648 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2649 INSERT);
2651 /* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't
2652 need to do it again. */
2653 if (*loc)
2655 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2656 return TRUE;
2659 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2661 if (! *loc)
2662 return FALSE;
2664 entry.gotidx = -1;
2665 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2667 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2669 if (h->got.offset != MINUS_ONE)
2670 return TRUE;
2672 /* By setting this to a value other than -1, we are indicating that
2673 there needs to be a GOT entry for H. Avoid using zero, as the
2674 generic ELF copy_indirect_symbol tests for <= 0. */
2675 if (tls_flag == 0)
2676 h->got.offset = 1;
2678 return TRUE;
2681 /* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol
2682 SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND. */
2684 static bfd_boolean
2685 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
2686 struct mips_got_info *g,
2687 unsigned char tls_flag)
2689 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2691 entry.abfd = abfd;
2692 entry.symndx = symndx;
2693 entry.d.addend = addend;
2694 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2695 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **)
2696 htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT);
2698 if (*loc)
2700 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
2702 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2703 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2705 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
2707 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2708 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2710 return TRUE;
2713 if (tls_flag != 0)
2715 entry.gotidx = -1;
2716 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2717 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE)
2718 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2719 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD)
2720 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2721 else if (g->tls_ldm_offset == MINUS_ONE)
2723 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_TWO;
2724 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2727 else
2729 entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++;
2730 entry.tls_type = 0;
2733 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2735 if (! *loc)
2736 return FALSE;
2738 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2740 return TRUE;
2743 /* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry. */
2745 static hashval_t
2746 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2748 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry
2749 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_;
2751 return entry->bfd->id;
2754 /* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd. */
2756 static int
2757 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2759 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1
2760 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1;
2761 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2
2762 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2;
2764 return e1->bfd == e2->bfd;
2767 /* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBFD. G must
2768 be the master GOT data. */
2770 static struct mips_got_info *
2771 mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
2773 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p;
2775 if (! g->bfd2got)
2776 return g;
2778 e.bfd = ibfd;
2779 p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e);
2780 return p ? p->g : NULL;
2783 /* Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global
2784 got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each
2785 bfd requires. */
2787 static int
2788 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
2790 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2791 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
2792 htab_t bfd2got = arg->bfd2got;
2793 struct mips_got_info *g;
2794 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot;
2795 void **bfdgotp;
2797 /* Find the got_info for this GOT entry's input bfd. Create one if
2798 none exists. */
2799 bfdgot_entry.bfd = entry->abfd;
2800 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT);
2801 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfdgotp;
2803 if (bfdgot != NULL)
2804 g = bfdgot->g;
2805 else
2807 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
2808 (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
2810 if (bfdgot == NULL)
2812 arg->obfd = 0;
2813 return 0;
2816 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
2818 bfdgot->bfd = entry->abfd;
2819 bfdgot->g = g = (struct mips_got_info *)
2820 bfd_alloc (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
2821 if (g == NULL)
2823 arg->obfd = 0;
2824 return 0;
2827 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
2828 g->global_gotno = 0;
2829 g->local_gotno = 0;
2830 g->assigned_gotno = -1;
2831 g->tls_gotno = 0;
2832 g->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
2833 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
2834 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
2835 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL);
2836 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
2838 arg->obfd = 0;
2839 return 0;
2842 g->bfd2got = NULL;
2843 g->next = NULL;
2846 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
2847 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
2848 if (*entryp != NULL)
2849 return 1;
2851 *entryp = entry;
2853 if (entry->tls_type)
2855 if (entry->tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
2856 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2857 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2858 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2860 else if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->forced_local)
2861 ++g->local_gotno;
2862 else
2863 ++g->global_gotno;
2865 return 1;
2868 /* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds. Try to use as much
2869 as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
2870 dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
2871 symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got,
2872 attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
2873 and then make make the new got current. */
2875 static int
2876 mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p)
2878 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got
2879 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_;
2880 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
2881 unsigned int lcount = bfd2got->g->local_gotno;
2882 unsigned int gcount = bfd2got->g->global_gotno;
2883 unsigned int tcount = bfd2got->g->tls_gotno;
2884 unsigned int maxcnt = arg->max_count;
2885 bfd_boolean too_many_for_tls = FALSE;
2887 /* We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals. The globals
2888 for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
2889 sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
2890 case. This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs. */
2891 if (tcount > 0)
2893 unsigned int primary_total = lcount + tcount + arg->global_count;
2894 if (primary_total * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (bfd2got->bfd)
2895 >= MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (bfd2got->bfd))
2896 too_many_for_tls = TRUE;
2899 /* If we don't have a primary GOT and this is not too big, use it as
2900 a starting point for the primary GOT. */
2901 if (! arg->primary && lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt
2902 && ! too_many_for_tls)
2904 arg->primary = bfd2got->g;
2905 arg->primary_count = lcount + gcount;
2907 /* If it looks like we can merge this bfd's entries with those of
2908 the primary, merge them. The heuristics is conservative, but we
2909 don't have to squeeze it too hard. */
2910 else if (arg->primary && ! too_many_for_tls
2911 && (arg->primary_count + lcount + gcount + tcount) <= maxcnt)
2913 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
2914 int old_lcount = arg->primary->local_gotno;
2915 int old_gcount = arg->primary->global_gotno;
2916 int old_tcount = arg->primary->tls_gotno;
2918 bfd2got->g = arg->primary;
2920 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
2921 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
2922 arg);
2923 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
2924 return 0;
2926 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
2927 /* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual
2928 got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash
2929 table anyway. */
2931 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->primary->local_gotno);
2932 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->primary->global_gotno);
2933 BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->primary->tls_gotno);
2935 arg->primary_count = arg->primary->local_gotno
2936 + arg->primary->global_gotno + arg->primary->tls_gotno;
2938 /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */
2939 else if (arg->current
2940 && arg->current_count + lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt)
2942 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
2943 int old_lcount = arg->current->local_gotno;
2944 int old_gcount = arg->current->global_gotno;
2945 int old_tcount = arg->current->tls_gotno;
2947 bfd2got->g = arg->current;
2949 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
2950 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
2951 arg);
2952 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
2953 return 0;
2955 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
2957 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->current->local_gotno);
2958 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->current->global_gotno);
2959 BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->current->tls_gotno);
2961 arg->current_count = arg->current->local_gotno
2962 + arg->current->global_gotno + arg->current->tls_gotno;
2964 /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it
2965 fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
2966 overflows anyway. */
2967 else
2969 bfd2got->g->next = arg->current;
2970 arg->current = bfd2got->g;
2972 arg->current_count = lcount + gcount + 2 * tcount;
2975 return 1;
2978 /* Set the TLS GOT index for the GOT entry in ENTRYP. */
2980 static int
2981 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index (void **entryp, void *p)
2983 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2984 struct mips_got_info *g = p;
2986 /* We're only interested in TLS symbols. */
2987 if (entry->tls_type == 0)
2988 return 1;
2990 if (entry->symndx == -1)
2992 /* There may be multiple mips_got_entry structs for a global variable
2993 if there is just one GOT. Just do this once. */
2994 if (g->next == NULL)
2996 if (entry->d.h->tls_type & GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE)
2998 entry->gotidx = entry->d.h->tls_got_offset;
2999 return 1;
3001 entry->d.h->tls_type |= GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE;
3004 else if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
3006 /* Similarly, there may be multiple structs for the LDM entry. */
3007 if (g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_TWO && g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_ONE)
3009 entry->gotidx = g->tls_ldm_offset;
3010 return 1;
3014 /* Initialize the GOT offset. */
3015 entry->gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (entry->abfd) * (long) g->tls_assigned_gotno;
3016 if (g->next == NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3017 entry->d.h->tls_got_offset = entry->gotidx;
3019 if (entry->tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3020 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 2;
3021 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3022 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 1;
3024 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
3025 g->tls_ldm_offset = entry->gotidx;
3027 return 1;
3030 /* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used
3031 to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary
3032 got) to the given VALUE.
3034 If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must
3035 not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of
3036 the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the
3037 global symbol. G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the
3038 first available global GOT entry in G. VALUE must contain the size
3039 of a GOT entry in bytes. For each global GOT entry that requires a
3040 dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is
3041 marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function
3042 stub. */
3043 static int
3044 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p)
3046 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3047 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg
3048 = (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p;
3049 struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
3051 if (g && entry->tls_type != GOT_NORMAL)
3052 arg->needed_relocs +=
3053 mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type,
3054 entry->symndx == -1 ? &entry->d.h->root : NULL);
3056 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1
3057 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1
3058 && entry->d.h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL)
3060 if (g)
3062 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL);
3064 entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++;
3065 if (arg->info->shared
3066 || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
3067 && entry->d.h->root.def_dynamic
3068 && !entry->d.h->root.def_regular))
3069 ++arg->needed_relocs;
3071 else
3072 entry->d.h->root.got.offset = arg->value;
3075 return 1;
3078 /* Mark any global symbols referenced in the GOT we are iterating over
3079 as inelligible for lazy resolution stubs. */
3080 static int
3081 mips_elf_set_no_stub (void **entryp, void *p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3083 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3085 if (entry->abfd != NULL
3086 && entry->symndx == -1
3087 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1)
3088 entry->d.h->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
3090 return 1;
3093 /* Follow indirect and warning hash entries so that each got entry
3094 points to the final symbol definition. P must point to a pointer
3095 to the hash table we're traversing. Since this traversal may
3096 modify the hash table, we set this pointer to NULL to indicate
3097 we've made a potentially-destructive change to the hash table, so
3098 the traversal must be restarted. */
3099 static int
3100 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry (void **entryp, void *p)
3102 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3103 htab_t got_entries = *(htab_t *)p;
3105 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3107 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = entry->d.h;
3109 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3110 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3111 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3113 if (entry->d.h == h)
3114 return 1;
3116 entry->d.h = h;
3118 /* If we can't find this entry with the new bfd hash, re-insert
3119 it, and get the traversal restarted. */
3120 if (! htab_find (got_entries, entry))
3122 htab_clear_slot (got_entries, entryp);
3123 entryp = htab_find_slot (got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3124 if (! *entryp)
3125 *entryp = entry;
3126 /* Abort the traversal, since the whole table may have
3127 moved, and leave it up to the parent to restart the
3128 process. */
3129 *(htab_t *)p = NULL;
3130 return 0;
3132 /* We might want to decrement the global_gotno count, but it's
3133 either too early or too late for that at this point. */
3136 return 1;
3139 /* Turn indirect got entries in a got_entries table into their final
3140 locations. */
3141 static void
3142 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g)
3144 htab_t got_entries;
3148 got_entries = g->got_entries;
3150 htab_traverse (got_entries,
3151 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry,
3152 &got_entries);
3154 while (got_entries == NULL);
3157 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
3158 the primary GOT. */
3159 static bfd_vma
3160 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
3162 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3163 return 0;
3165 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
3166 if (! g)
3167 return 0;
3169 BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
3171 g = g->next;
3173 return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno)
3174 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3177 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
3178 a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */
3180 static bfd_boolean
3181 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3182 struct mips_got_info *g, asection *got,
3183 bfd_size_type pages)
3185 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
3186 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
3187 struct mips_got_info *gg;
3188 unsigned int assign;
3190 g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash,
3191 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL);
3192 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3193 return FALSE;
3195 got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got;
3196 got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
3197 got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
3199 /* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a
3200 map from bfd to got info while at that. */
3201 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3202 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3203 return FALSE;
3205 got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
3206 got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
3207 /* Taking out PAGES entries is a worst-case estimate. We could
3208 compute the maximum number of pages that each separate input bfd
3209 uses, but it's probably not worth it. */
3210 got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (abfd)
3211 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
3212 - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO - pages);
3213 /* The number of globals that will be included in the primary GOT.
3214 See the calls to mips_elf_set_global_got_offset below for more
3215 information. */
3216 got_per_bfd_arg.global_count = g->global_gotno;
3218 /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
3219 don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
3220 to be the primary GOT. */
3221 htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3222 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3223 return FALSE;
3225 /* If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */
3226 if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
3228 g->next = (struct mips_got_info *)
3229 bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3230 if (g->next == NULL)
3231 return FALSE;
3233 g->next->global_gotsym = NULL;
3234 g->next->global_gotno = 0;
3235 g->next->local_gotno = 0;
3236 g->next->tls_gotno = 0;
3237 g->next->assigned_gotno = 0;
3238 g->next->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3239 g->next->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3240 g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3241 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq,
3242 NULL);
3243 if (g->next->got_entries == NULL)
3244 return FALSE;
3245 g->next->bfd2got = NULL;
3247 else
3248 g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
3249 g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
3251 /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */
3252 gg = g;
3253 g = g->next;
3255 /* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going
3256 to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
3257 didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
3258 We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
3259 list. */
3261 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot;
3262 void **bfdgotp;
3264 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
3265 (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
3267 if (bfdgot == NULL)
3268 return FALSE;
3270 bfdgot->bfd = abfd;
3271 bfdgot->g = g;
3272 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT);
3274 BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL);
3275 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3278 /* The IRIX dynamic linker requires every symbol that is referenced
3279 in a dynamic relocation to be present in the primary GOT, so
3280 arrange for them to appear after those that are actually
3281 referenced.
3283 GNU/Linux could very well do without it, but it would slow down
3284 the dynamic linker, since it would have to resolve every dynamic
3285 symbol referenced in other GOTs more than once, without help from
3286 the cache. Also, knowing that every external symbol has a GOT
3287 helps speed up the resolution of local symbols too, so GNU/Linux
3288 follows IRIX's practice.
3290 The number 2 is used by mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f to count
3291 global GOT symbols that are unreferenced in the primary GOT, with
3292 an initial dynamic index computed from gg->assigned_gotno, where
3293 the number of unreferenced global entries in the primary GOT is
3294 preserved. */
3295 if (1)
3297 gg->assigned_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
3298 g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
3299 set_got_offset_arg.value = 2;
3301 else
3303 /* This could be used for dynamic linkers that don't optimize
3304 symbol resolution while applying relocations so as to use
3305 primary GOT entries or assuming the symbol is locally-defined.
3306 With this code, we assign lower dynamic indices to global
3307 symbols that are not referenced in the primary GOT, so that
3308 their entries can be omitted. */
3309 gg->assigned_gotno = 0;
3310 set_got_offset_arg.value = -1;
3313 /* Reorder dynamic symbols as described above (which behavior
3314 depends on the setting of VALUE). */
3315 set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL;
3316 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3317 &set_got_offset_arg);
3318 set_got_offset_arg.value = 1;
3319 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3320 &set_got_offset_arg);
3321 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
3322 return FALSE;
3324 /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
3325 [assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
3326 entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by
3327 adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make
3328 it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
3329 beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To
3330 avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
3331 assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
3332 we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
3333 global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
3334 offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT
3335 will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
3336 points back to the master GOT. */
3337 gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
3338 gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
3339 gg->tls_gotno = 0;
3340 assign = 0;
3341 gg->next = gg;
3345 struct mips_got_info *gn;
3347 assign += MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
3348 g->assigned_gotno = assign;
3349 g->local_gotno += assign + pages;
3350 assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
3352 /* Set up any TLS entries. We always place the TLS entries after
3353 all non-TLS entries. */
3354 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
3355 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
3357 /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
3358 list that gg points to. */
3359 gn = g->next;
3360 g->next = gg->next;
3361 gg->next = g;
3362 g = gn;
3364 /* Mark global symbols in every non-primary GOT as ineligible for
3365 stubs. */
3366 if (g)
3367 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_no_stub, NULL);
3369 while (g);
3371 got->size = (gg->next->local_gotno
3372 + gg->next->global_gotno
3373 + gg->next->tls_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3375 return TRUE;
3379 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
3380 RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */
3382 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
3383 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
3384 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3385 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
3387 while (relocation < relend)
3389 if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type)
3390 return relocation;
3392 ++relocation;
3395 /* We didn't find it. */
3396 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3397 return NULL;
3400 /* Return whether a relocation is against a local symbol. */
3402 static bfd_boolean
3403 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
3404 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3405 asection **local_sections,
3406 bfd_boolean check_forced)
3408 unsigned long r_symndx;
3409 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3410 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3411 size_t extsymoff;
3413 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3414 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3415 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3417 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
3418 return TRUE;
3419 if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
3420 return TRUE;
3422 if (check_forced)
3424 /* Look up the hash table to check whether the symbol
3425 was forced local. */
3426 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3427 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
3428 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
3429 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3430 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3431 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3432 if (h->root.forced_local)
3433 return TRUE;
3436 return FALSE;
3439 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */
3441 bfd_vma
3442 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3444 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
3445 /* VALUE is negative. */
3446 value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
3448 return value;
3451 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
3452 range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
3453 BITS. */
3455 static bfd_boolean
3456 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3458 bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
3460 if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
3461 /* The value is too big. */
3462 return TRUE;
3463 else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
3464 /* The value is too small. */
3465 return TRUE;
3467 /* All is well. */
3468 return FALSE;
3471 /* Calculate the %high function. */
3473 static bfd_vma
3474 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
3476 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
3479 /* Calculate the %higher function. */
3481 static bfd_vma
3482 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3484 #ifdef BFD64
3485 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
3486 #else
3487 abort ();
3488 return MINUS_ONE;
3489 #endif
3492 /* Calculate the %highest function. */
3494 static bfd_vma
3495 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3497 #ifdef BFD64
3498 return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
3499 #else
3500 abort ();
3501 return MINUS_ONE;
3502 #endif
3505 /* Create the .compact_rel section. */
3507 static bfd_boolean
3508 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
3509 (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3511 flagword flags;
3512 register asection *s;
3514 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
3516 flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
3517 | SEC_READONLY);
3519 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".compact_rel", flags);
3520 if (s == NULL
3521 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
3522 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
3523 return FALSE;
3525 s->size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
3528 return TRUE;
3531 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */
3533 static bfd_boolean
3534 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3535 bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)
3537 flagword flags;
3538 register asection *s;
3539 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3540 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
3541 struct mips_got_info *g;
3542 bfd_size_type amt;
3544 /* This function may be called more than once. */
3545 s = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
3546 if (s)
3548 if (! maybe_exclude)
3549 s->flags &= ~SEC_EXCLUDE;
3550 return TRUE;
3553 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3554 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3556 if (maybe_exclude)
3557 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
3559 /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
3560 in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */
3561 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3562 if (s == NULL
3563 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
3564 return FALSE;
3566 /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the
3567 linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
3568 are not creating a global offset table. */
3569 bh = NULL;
3570 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
3571 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
3572 0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
3573 return FALSE;
3575 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
3576 h->non_elf = 0;
3577 h->def_regular = 1;
3578 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
3579 elf_hash_table (info)->hgot = h;
3581 if (info->shared
3582 && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3583 return FALSE;
3585 amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info);
3586 g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
3587 if (g == NULL)
3588 return FALSE;
3589 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3590 g->global_gotno = 0;
3591 g->tls_gotno = 0;
3592 g->local_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
3593 g->assigned_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
3594 g->bfd2got = NULL;
3595 g->next = NULL;
3596 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3597 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
3598 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3599 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3600 return FALSE;
3601 mips_elf_section_data (s)->u.got_info = g;
3602 mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
3603 |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
3605 return TRUE;
3608 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
3609 the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
3610 RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
3612 The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
3613 REQUIRE_JALXP indicates whether or not the opcode used with this
3614 relocation must be JALX.
3616 This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
3617 further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
3618 something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
3619 overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */
3621 static bfd_reloc_status_type
3622 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
3623 asection *input_section,
3624 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3625 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3626 bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
3627 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
3628 asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
3629 const char **namep, bfd_boolean *require_jalxp,
3630 bfd_boolean save_addend)
3632 /* The eventual value we will return. */
3633 bfd_vma value;
3634 /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
3635 occurring. */
3636 bfd_vma symbol = 0;
3637 /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
3638 shared object file being produced. */
3639 bfd_vma gp = MINUS_ONE;
3640 /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
3641 relocated. */
3642 bfd_vma p;
3643 /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */
3644 bfd_vma gp0 = MINUS_ONE;
3645 /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
3646 the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
3647 during execution. */
3648 bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
3649 /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
3650 located. */
3651 asection *sec = NULL;
3652 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
3653 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
3654 symbol. */
3655 bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
3656 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */
3657 bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
3658 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is
3659 "__gnu_local_gp". */
3660 bfd_boolean gnu_local_gp_p = FALSE;
3661 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3662 size_t extsymoff;
3663 unsigned long r_symndx;
3664 int r_type;
3665 /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
3666 relocation value. */
3667 bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
3668 /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */
3669 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
3671 /* Parse the relocation. */
3672 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3673 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3674 p = (input_section->output_section->vma
3675 + input_section->output_offset
3676 + relocation->r_offset);
3678 /* Assume that there will be no overflow. */
3679 overflowed_p = FALSE;
3681 /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
3682 used in the array of hash table entries. */
3683 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3684 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
3685 local_sections, FALSE);
3686 was_local_p = local_p;
3687 if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
3688 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3689 else
3691 /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
3692 must come before globals. */
3693 extsymoff = 0;
3696 /* Figure out the value of the symbol. */
3697 if (local_p)
3699 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
3701 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
3702 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
3704 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3705 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION
3706 || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
3707 symbol += sym->st_value;
3708 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
3709 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
3711 addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
3712 addend -= symbol;
3713 addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3716 /* MIPS16 text labels should be treated as odd. */
3717 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
3718 ++symbol;
3720 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
3721 *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
3722 symtab_hdr->sh_link,
3723 sym->st_name);
3724 if (*namep == '\0')
3725 *namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
3727 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16);
3729 else
3731 /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */
3733 /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */
3734 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3735 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
3736 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
3737 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3738 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3739 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3741 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
3742 *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
3744 /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a
3745 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
3746 if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
3747 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
3749 /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
3750 R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */
3751 if (r_type != R_MIPS_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS_LO16
3752 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
3753 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
3755 gp_disp_p = TRUE;
3757 /* See if this is the special _gp symbol. Note that such a
3758 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
3759 else if (strcmp (*namep, "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
3760 gnu_local_gp_p = TRUE;
3763 /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that
3764 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
3765 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
3766 its defined. */
3767 else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
3768 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3769 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
3771 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
3772 if (sec->output_section)
3773 symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
3774 + sec->output_section->vma
3775 + sec->output_offset);
3776 else
3777 symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
3779 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
3780 /* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
3781 it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
3782 and check to see if they exist by looking at their
3783 addresses. */
3784 symbol = 0;
3785 else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
3786 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
3787 symbol = 0;
3788 else if (strcmp (*namep, SGI_COMPAT (input_bfd)
3789 ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
3791 /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
3792 _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
3793 in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
3794 Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
3795 FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
3796 somehow as well. */
3797 BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared);
3798 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
3799 symbol = 0;
3801 else if (ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->root.other))
3803 /* This is an optional symbol - an Irix specific extension to the
3804 ELF spec. Ignore it for now.
3805 XXX - FIXME - there is more to the spec for OPTIONAL symbols
3806 than simply ignoring them, but we do not handle this for now.
3807 For information see the "64-bit ELF Object File Specification"
3808 which is available from here:
3809 http://techpubs.sgi.com/library/manuals/4000/007-4658-001/pdf/007-4658-001.pdf */
3810 symbol = 0;
3812 else
3814 if (! ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
3815 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
3816 input_section, relocation->r_offset,
3817 (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
3818 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other))))
3819 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
3820 symbol = 0;
3823 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (h->root.other == STO_MIPS16);
3826 /* If this is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function with a stub, we
3827 need to redirect the call to the stub, unless we're already *in*
3828 a stub. */
3829 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
3830 && ((h != NULL && h->fn_stub != NULL)
3831 || (local_p && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
3832 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
3833 && !mips_elf_stub_section_p (input_bfd, input_section))
3835 /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should
3836 have already noticed that we were going to need the
3837 stub. */
3838 if (local_p)
3839 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
3840 else
3842 BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
3843 sec = h->fn_stub;
3846 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3848 /* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we
3849 need to redirect the call to the stub. */
3850 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
3851 && h != NULL
3852 && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
3853 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
3855 /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
3856 out which one to use by seeing which one appears in the input
3857 file. */
3858 if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
3860 asection *o;
3862 sec = NULL;
3863 for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
3865 if (strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o),
3866 CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
3868 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
3869 break;
3872 if (sec == NULL)
3873 sec = h->call_stub;
3875 else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
3876 sec = h->call_stub;
3877 else
3878 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
3880 BFD_ASSERT (sec->size > 0);
3881 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3884 /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
3885 special jalx instruction. */
3886 *require_jalxp = (!info->relocatable
3887 && (((r_type == R_MIPS16_26) && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
3888 || ((r_type == R_MIPS_26) && target_is_16_bit_code_p)));
3890 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
3891 local_sections, TRUE);
3893 /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, or the GP value,
3894 and we're going to need it, get it now. */
3895 switch (r_type)
3897 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
3898 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
3899 /* We need to decay to GOT_DISP/addend if the symbol doesn't
3900 bind locally. */
3901 local_p = local_p || _bfd_elf_symbol_refs_local_p (&h->root, info, 1);
3902 if (local_p || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_OFST)
3903 break;
3904 /* Fall through. */
3906 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
3907 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
3908 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
3909 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
3910 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
3911 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
3912 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
3913 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
3914 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
3915 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
3916 /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */
3917 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
3919 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info, 0, 0, NULL,
3920 r_type);
3921 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
3922 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
3924 else if (!local_p)
3926 /* GOT_PAGE may take a non-zero addend, that is ignored in a
3927 GOT_PAGE relocation that decays to GOT_DISP because the
3928 symbol turns out to be global. The addend is then added
3929 as GOT_OFST. */
3930 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
3931 g = mips_elf_global_got_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
3932 input_bfd,
3933 (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h,
3934 r_type, info);
3935 if (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL
3936 && (! elf_hash_table(info)->dynamic_sections_created
3937 || (info->shared
3938 && (info->symbolic || h->root.forced_local)
3939 && h->root.def_regular)))
3941 /* This is a static link or a -Bsymbolic link. The
3942 symbol is defined locally, or was forced to be local.
3943 We must initialize this entry in the GOT. */
3944 bfd *tmpbfd = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3945 asection *sgot = mips_elf_got_section (tmpbfd, FALSE);
3946 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (tmpbfd, symbol, sgot->contents + g);
3949 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16)
3950 /* There's no need to create a local GOT entry here; the
3951 calculation for a local GOT16 entry does not involve G. */
3952 break;
3953 else
3955 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd,
3956 info, symbol + addend, r_symndx, h,
3957 r_type);
3958 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
3959 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
3962 /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */
3963 g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
3964 abfd, input_bfd, g);
3965 break;
3967 case R_MIPS_HI16:
3968 case R_MIPS_LO16:
3969 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
3970 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
3971 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
3972 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
3973 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
3974 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
3975 gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
3976 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
3977 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj)
3978 gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd,
3979 mips_elf_got_info
3980 (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, NULL),
3981 input_bfd);
3982 break;
3984 default:
3985 break;
3988 if (gnu_local_gp_p)
3989 symbol = gp;
3991 /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */
3992 switch (r_type)
3994 case R_MIPS_NONE:
3995 return bfd_reloc_continue;
3997 case R_MIPS_16:
3998 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
3999 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4000 break;
4002 case R_MIPS_32:
4003 case R_MIPS_REL32:
4004 case R_MIPS_64:
4005 if ((info->shared
4006 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
4007 && h != NULL
4008 && h->root.def_dynamic
4009 && !h->root.def_regular))
4010 && r_symndx != 0
4011 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4013 /* If we're creating a shared library, or this relocation is
4014 against a symbol in a shared library, then we can't know
4015 where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation
4016 record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
4017 linker. */
4018 value = addend;
4019 if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
4020 info,
4021 relocation,
4023 sec,
4024 symbol,
4025 &value,
4026 input_section))
4027 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4029 else
4031 if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4032 value = symbol + addend;
4033 else
4034 value = addend;
4036 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4037 break;
4039 case R_MIPS_PC32:
4040 value = symbol + addend - p;
4041 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4042 break;
4044 case R_MIPS16_26:
4045 /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
4046 R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into
4047 the output file that's different. That's handled in
4048 mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the
4049 R_MIPS_26 case here. */
4050 case R_MIPS_26:
4051 if (local_p)
4052 value = ((addend | ((p + 4) & 0xf0000000)) + symbol) >> 2;
4053 else
4055 value = (_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28) + symbol) >> 2;
4056 if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4057 overflowed_p = (value >> 26) != ((p + 4) >> 28);
4059 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4060 break;
4062 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
4063 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - dtprel_base (info))
4064 & howto->dst_mask);
4065 break;
4067 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
4068 value = (symbol + addend - dtprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4069 break;
4071 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
4072 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - tprel_base (info))
4073 & howto->dst_mask);
4074 break;
4076 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
4077 value = (symbol + addend - tprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4078 break;
4080 case R_MIPS_HI16:
4081 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4082 if (!gp_disp_p)
4084 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
4085 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4087 else
4089 /* For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
4090 0: li $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
4091 4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
4092 8: sll $v0,16
4093 12: addu $v0,$v1
4094 14: move $gp,$v0
4095 So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
4096 $pc is four higher than $t9 would be, so reduce
4097 both reloc addends by 4. */
4098 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
4099 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p - 4);
4100 else
4101 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
4102 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4104 break;
4106 case R_MIPS_LO16:
4107 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4108 if (!gp_disp_p)
4109 value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
4110 else
4112 /* See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
4113 for this conditional. */
4114 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16)
4115 value = addend + gp - p;
4116 else
4117 value = addend + gp - p + 4;
4118 /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
4119 for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
4120 _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
4121 pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like
4122 this:
4124 lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
4125 addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
4126 addu $gp,$gp,$t9
4128 Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
4129 as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16
4130 relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
4131 R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
4132 Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
4133 not check for overflow here. */
4135 break;
4137 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4138 /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
4139 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge
4140 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
4141 here. */
4143 /* Fall through. */
4145 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4146 /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
4147 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
4148 order. We don't need to do anything special here; the
4149 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */
4150 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4151 /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
4152 instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
4153 otherwise we may lose significant bits. */
4154 if (howto->partial_inplace)
4155 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4156 value = symbol + addend - gp;
4157 /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
4158 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
4159 for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
4160 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
4161 to them before. */
4162 if (was_local_p)
4163 value += gp0;
4164 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4165 break;
4167 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4168 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4169 if (local_p)
4171 bfd_boolean forced;
4173 /* The special case is when the symbol is forced to be local. We
4174 need the full address in the GOT since no R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
4175 follows. */
4176 forced = ! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4177 local_sections, FALSE);
4178 value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4179 symbol + addend, forced);
4180 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4181 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4182 value
4183 = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
4184 abfd, input_bfd, value);
4185 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4186 break;
4189 /* Fall through. */
4191 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4192 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4193 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4194 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4195 got_disp:
4196 value = g;
4197 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4198 break;
4200 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4201 value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
4202 if (!save_addend)
4203 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4204 break;
4206 case R_MIPS_PC16:
4207 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
4208 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p;
4209 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
4210 value = (value >> 2) & howto->dst_mask;
4211 break;
4213 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4214 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4215 /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
4216 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
4217 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */
4218 value = g;
4219 value = mips_elf_high (value);
4220 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4221 break;
4223 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4224 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4225 value = g & howto->dst_mask;
4226 break;
4228 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4229 /* GOT_PAGE relocations that reference non-local symbols decay
4230 to GOT_DISP. The corresponding GOT_OFST relocation decays to
4231 0. */
4232 if (! local_p)
4233 goto got_disp;
4234 value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
4235 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4236 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4237 value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj,
4238 abfd, input_bfd, value);
4239 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4240 break;
4242 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4243 if (local_p)
4244 mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
4245 else
4246 value = addend;
4247 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4248 break;
4250 case R_MIPS_SUB:
4251 value = symbol - addend;
4252 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4253 break;
4255 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
4256 value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
4257 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4258 break;
4260 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
4261 value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
4262 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4263 break;
4265 case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
4266 value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
4267 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4268 break;
4270 case R_MIPS_JALR:
4271 /* This relocation is only a hint. In some cases, we optimize
4272 it into a bal instruction. But we don't try to optimize
4273 branches to the PLT; that will wind up wasting time. */
4274 if (h != NULL && h->root.plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
4275 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4276 value = symbol + addend;
4277 break;
4279 case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
4280 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4281 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
4282 /* We don't do anything with these at present. */
4283 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4285 default:
4286 /* An unrecognized relocation type. */
4287 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
4290 /* Store the VALUE for our caller. */
4291 *valuep = value;
4292 return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
4295 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
4297 static bfd_vma
4298 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
4299 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4300 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
4302 bfd_vma x;
4303 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4305 /* Obtain the bytes. */
4306 x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location);
4308 return x;
4311 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
4312 VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
4313 appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the
4314 relocation applies. If REQUIRE_JALX is TRUE, then the opcode used
4315 for the relocation must be either JAL or JALX, and it is
4316 unconditionally converted to JALX.
4318 Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */
4320 static bfd_boolean
4321 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4322 reloc_howto_type *howto,
4323 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4324 bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
4325 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
4326 bfd_boolean require_jalx)
4328 bfd_vma x;
4329 bfd_byte *location;
4330 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4332 /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */
4333 location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4335 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
4337 /* Obtain the current value. */
4338 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
4340 /* Clear the field we are setting. */
4341 x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
4343 /* Set the field. */
4344 x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
4346 /* If required, turn JAL into JALX. */
4347 if (require_jalx)
4349 bfd_boolean ok;
4350 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
4351 bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
4353 /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */
4354 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
4356 ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
4357 jalx_opcode = 0x7;
4359 else
4361 ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
4362 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
4365 /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. */
4366 if (!ok)
4368 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4369 (_("%B: %A+0x%lx: jump to stub routine which is not jal"),
4370 input_bfd,
4371 input_section,
4372 (unsigned long) relocation->r_offset);
4373 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4374 return FALSE;
4377 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
4378 x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
4381 /* On the RM9000, bal is faster than jal, because bal uses branch
4382 prediction hardware. If we are linking for the RM9000, and we
4383 see jal, and bal fits, use it instead. Note that this
4384 transformation should be safe for all architectures. */
4385 if (bfd_get_mach (input_bfd) == bfd_mach_mips9000
4386 && !info->relocatable
4387 && !require_jalx
4388 && ((r_type == R_MIPS_26 && (x >> 26) == 0x3) /* jal addr */
4389 || (r_type == R_MIPS_JALR && x == 0x0320f809))) /* jalr t9 */
4391 bfd_vma addr;
4392 bfd_vma dest;
4393 bfd_signed_vma off;
4395 addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
4396 + input_section->output_offset
4397 + relocation->r_offset
4398 + 4);
4399 if (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
4400 dest = (value << 2) | ((addr >> 28) << 28);
4401 else
4402 dest = value;
4403 off = dest - addr;
4404 if (off <= 0x1ffff && off >= -0x20000)
4405 x = 0x04110000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* bal addr */
4408 /* Put the value into the output. */
4409 bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location);
4411 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, !info->relocatable,
4412 location);
4414 return TRUE;
4417 /* Returns TRUE if SECTION is a MIPS16 stub section. */
4419 static bfd_boolean
4420 mips_elf_stub_section_p (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section)
4422 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, section);
4424 return (strncmp (name, FN_STUB, sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0
4425 || strncmp (name, CALL_STUB, sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
4426 || strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0);
4429 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel.dyn section in ABFD. */
4431 static void
4432 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, unsigned int n)
4434 asection *s;
4436 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (abfd, FALSE);
4437 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4439 if (s->size == 0)
4441 /* Make room for a null element. */
4442 s->size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4443 ++s->reloc_count;
4445 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4448 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL
4449 is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
4450 dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
4451 caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */
4453 static bfd_boolean
4454 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
4455 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4456 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4457 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4458 asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
4459 bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
4461 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
4462 asection *sreloc;
4463 bfd *dynobj;
4464 int r_type;
4465 long indx;
4466 bfd_boolean defined_p;
4468 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
4469 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4470 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
4471 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
4472 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
4473 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
4474 < sreloc->size);
4476 outrel[0].r_offset =
4477 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
4478 outrel[1].r_offset =
4479 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
4480 outrel[2].r_offset =
4481 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
4483 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_ONE)
4484 /* The relocation field has been deleted. */
4485 return TRUE;
4487 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_TWO)
4489 /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
4490 some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
4491 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */
4492 *addendp += symbol;
4493 return TRUE;
4496 /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
4497 in the relocation. */
4498 if (h != NULL
4499 && (!h->root.def_regular
4500 || (info->shared && !info->symbolic && !h->root.forced_local)))
4502 indx = h->root.dynindx;
4503 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4504 defined_p = h->root.def_regular;
4505 else
4506 /* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
4507 relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against
4508 defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
4509 undefined symbols. */
4510 defined_p = FALSE;
4512 else
4514 if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
4515 indx = 0;
4516 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
4518 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4519 return FALSE;
4521 else
4523 indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
4524 if (indx == 0)
4525 abort ();
4528 /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
4529 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
4530 relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to
4531 local symbols because we used to generate them
4532 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
4533 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In
4534 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
4535 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
4536 section-relative relocations. It's not like they're
4537 useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient
4538 as well. */
4539 /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
4540 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
4541 a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations
4542 against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */
4543 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4544 indx = 0;
4545 defined_p = TRUE;
4548 /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
4549 this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
4550 adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
4551 Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */
4552 if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4553 *addendp += symbol;
4555 /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
4556 know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */
4557 outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
4558 R_MIPS_REL32);
4559 /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
4560 generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
4561 _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
4562 a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
4563 However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
4564 loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
4565 artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true,
4566 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
4567 as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
4568 invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
4569 additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
4570 NULL symbol before this relocation record. */
4571 outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
4572 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
4573 ? R_MIPS_64
4574 : R_MIPS_NONE);
4575 outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
4577 /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
4578 correct location in the output file. */
4579 outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4580 + input_section->output_offset);
4581 outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4582 + input_section->output_offset);
4583 outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4584 + input_section->output_offset);
4586 /* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special
4587 relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
4588 relocation format is non-standard. */
4589 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4591 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
4592 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4593 (sreloc->contents
4594 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
4596 else
4597 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
4598 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4599 (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
4601 /* We've now added another relocation. */
4602 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
4604 /* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker
4605 will be writing to it. */
4606 elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
4607 |= SHF_WRITE;
4609 /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */
4610 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
4612 asection *scpt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
4613 bfd_byte *cr;
4615 if (scpt)
4617 Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
4619 mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
4620 cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
4621 + input_section->output_section->vma
4622 + input_section->output_offset);
4623 if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
4624 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
4625 else
4626 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
4627 mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
4628 cptrel.konst = *addendp;
4630 cr = (scpt->contents
4631 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
4632 mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr (cptrel, 0);
4633 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
4634 ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
4635 + scpt->reloc_count));
4636 ++scpt->reloc_count;
4640 return TRUE;
4643 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */
4645 unsigned long
4646 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
4648 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
4650 case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
4651 return bfd_mach_mips3900;
4653 case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
4654 return bfd_mach_mips4010;
4656 case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
4657 return bfd_mach_mips4100;
4659 case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
4660 return bfd_mach_mips4111;
4662 case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
4663 return bfd_mach_mips4120;
4665 case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
4666 return bfd_mach_mips4650;
4668 case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
4669 return bfd_mach_mips5400;
4671 case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
4672 return bfd_mach_mips5500;
4674 case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
4675 return bfd_mach_mips9000;
4677 case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
4678 return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
4680 default:
4681 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
4683 default:
4684 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
4685 return bfd_mach_mips3000;
4686 break;
4688 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
4689 return bfd_mach_mips6000;
4690 break;
4692 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
4693 return bfd_mach_mips4000;
4694 break;
4696 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
4697 return bfd_mach_mips8000;
4698 break;
4700 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
4701 return bfd_mach_mips5;
4702 break;
4704 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
4705 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
4706 break;
4708 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
4709 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
4710 break;
4712 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
4713 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
4714 break;
4716 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
4717 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
4718 break;
4722 return 0;
4725 /* Return printable name for ABI. */
4727 static INLINE char *
4728 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
4730 flagword flags;
4732 flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
4733 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
4735 case 0:
4736 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
4737 return "N32";
4738 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
4739 return "64";
4740 else
4741 return "none";
4742 case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
4743 return "O32";
4744 case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
4745 return "O64";
4746 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
4747 return "EABI32";
4748 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
4749 return "EABI64";
4750 default:
4751 return "unknown abi";
4755 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the
4756 other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept
4757 together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
4758 faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common
4759 section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */
4760 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
4761 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
4762 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
4764 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
4765 allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
4766 definition in a shared library. */
4767 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
4768 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
4769 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
4771 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use.
4772 This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
4774 void
4775 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
4777 elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
4779 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
4780 switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
4782 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
4783 /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
4784 It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can
4785 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
4786 library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes,
4787 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */
4788 if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
4790 /* Initialize the acommon section. */
4791 mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
4792 mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
4793 mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
4794 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
4795 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
4796 mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
4797 mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
4798 mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
4799 mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
4801 asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
4802 break;
4804 case SHN_COMMON:
4805 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
4806 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */
4807 if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
4808 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
4809 break;
4810 /* Fall through. */
4811 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
4812 if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
4814 /* Initialize the small common section. */
4815 mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
4816 mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
4817 mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
4818 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
4819 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
4820 mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
4821 mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
4822 mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
4823 mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
4825 asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
4826 asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
4827 break;
4829 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
4830 asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
4831 break;
4833 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
4835 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".text");
4837 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
4838 if (section != NULL)
4840 asym->section = section;
4841 /* MIPS_TEXT is a bit special, the address is not an offset
4842 to the base of the .text section. So substract the section
4843 base address to make it an offset. */
4844 asym->value -= section->vma;
4847 break;
4849 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
4851 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".data");
4853 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
4854 if (section != NULL)
4856 asym->section = section;
4857 /* MIPS_DATA is a bit special, the address is not an offset
4858 to the base of the .data section. So substract the section
4859 base address to make it an offset. */
4860 asym->value -= section->vma;
4863 break;
4867 /* Implement elf_backend_eh_frame_address_size. This differs from
4868 the default in the way it handles EABI64.
4870 EABI64 was originally specified as an LP64 ABI, and that is what
4871 -mabi=eabi normally gives on a 64-bit target. However, gcc has
4872 historically accepted the combination of -mabi=eabi and -mlong32,
4873 and this ILP32 variation has become semi-official over time.
4874 Both forms use elf32 and have pointer-sized FDE addresses.
4876 If an EABI object was generated by GCC 4.0 or above, it will have
4877 an empty .gcc_compiled_longXX section, where XX is the size of longs
4878 in bits. Unfortunately, ILP32 objects generated by earlier compilers
4879 have no special marking to distinguish them from LP64 objects.
4881 We don't want users of the official LP64 ABI to be punished for the
4882 existence of the ILP32 variant, but at the same time, we don't want
4883 to mistakenly interpret pre-4.0 ILP32 objects as being LP64 objects.
4884 We therefore take the following approach:
4886 - If ABFD contains a .gcc_compiled_longXX section, use it to
4887 determine the pointer size.
4889 - Otherwise check the type of the first relocation. Assume that
4890 the LP64 ABI is being used if the relocation is of type R_MIPS_64.
4892 - Otherwise punt.
4894 The second check is enough to detect LP64 objects generated by pre-4.0
4895 compilers because, in the kind of output generated by those compilers,
4896 the first relocation will be associated with either a CIE personality
4897 routine or an FDE start address. Furthermore, the compilers never
4898 used a special (non-pointer) encoding for this ABI.
4900 Checking the relocation type should also be safe because there is no
4901 reason to use R_MIPS_64 in an ILP32 object. Pre-4.0 compilers never
4902 did so. */
4904 unsigned int
4905 _bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
4907 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
4908 return 8;
4909 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
4911 bfd_boolean long32_p, long64_p;
4913 long32_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long32") != 0;
4914 long64_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long64") != 0;
4915 if (long32_p && long64_p)
4916 return 0;
4917 if (long32_p)
4918 return 4;
4919 if (long64_p)
4920 return 8;
4922 if (sec->reloc_count > 0
4923 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != NULL
4924 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs[0].r_info)
4925 == R_MIPS_64))
4926 return 8;
4928 return 0;
4930 return 4;
4933 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
4934 relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
4935 same address. For example, if we have code like:
4937 lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
4938 lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
4939 jalr $25
4941 then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
4942 will jump there rather than to .text.
4944 We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
4945 This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */
4947 bfd_boolean
4948 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
4950 return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
4953 /* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is
4954 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize
4955 sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
4956 a better way. */
4958 bfd_boolean
4959 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
4961 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
4962 && hdr->sh_size > 0)
4964 bfd_byte buf[4];
4966 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
4967 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
4969 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
4970 hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
4971 SEEK_SET) != 0)
4972 return FALSE;
4973 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
4974 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
4975 return FALSE;
4978 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
4979 && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
4980 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
4981 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
4983 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
4985 /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
4986 set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents
4987 so that we don't have to read them again.
4988 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
4989 through the section contents to see if there is an
4990 ODK_REGINFO structure. */
4992 contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
4993 l = contents;
4994 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
4995 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
4997 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
4999 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5000 &intopt);
5001 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5003 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5004 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5005 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5006 break;
5008 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5010 bfd_byte buf[8];
5012 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5013 (hdr->sh_offset
5014 + (l - contents)
5015 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5016 + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
5017 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5018 return FALSE;
5019 H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5020 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
5021 return FALSE;
5023 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5025 bfd_byte buf[4];
5027 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5028 (hdr->sh_offset
5029 + (l - contents)
5030 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5031 + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
5032 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5033 return FALSE;
5034 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5035 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5036 return FALSE;
5038 l += intopt.size;
5042 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
5044 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
5046 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5047 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
5048 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
5050 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5051 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5053 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
5055 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5056 hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
5058 else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
5060 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5061 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5063 else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
5065 hdr->sh_flags = 0;
5066 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5068 else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
5070 if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
5072 unsigned int adjust;
5074 adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
5075 if (adjust != 0)
5076 hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
5081 return TRUE;
5084 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This
5085 is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
5086 This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
5088 FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
5089 how to. */
5091 bfd_boolean
5092 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
5093 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
5094 const char *name,
5095 int shindex)
5097 flagword flags = 0;
5099 /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
5100 at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
5101 sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
5102 suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
5103 probably get away with this. */
5104 switch (hdr->sh_type)
5106 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
5107 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
5108 return FALSE;
5109 break;
5110 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
5111 if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
5112 return FALSE;
5113 break;
5114 case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
5115 if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
5116 return FALSE;
5117 break;
5118 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
5119 if (strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) != 0)
5120 return FALSE;
5121 break;
5122 case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
5123 if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
5124 return FALSE;
5125 break;
5126 case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
5127 if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
5128 return FALSE;
5129 flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
5130 break;
5131 case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
5132 if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
5133 || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
5134 return FALSE;
5135 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
5136 break;
5137 case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
5138 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
5139 return FALSE;
5140 break;
5141 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
5142 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content", sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1) != 0)
5143 return FALSE;
5144 break;
5145 case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
5146 if (!MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5147 return FALSE;
5148 break;
5149 case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
5150 if (strncmp (name, ".debug_", sizeof ".debug_" - 1) != 0)
5151 return FALSE;
5152 break;
5153 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
5154 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
5155 return FALSE;
5156 break;
5157 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
5158 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) != 0
5159 && strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
5160 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) != 0)
5161 return FALSE;
5162 break;
5163 default:
5164 break;
5167 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
5168 return FALSE;
5170 if (flags)
5172 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5173 (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
5174 hdr->bfd_section)
5175 | flags)))
5176 return FALSE;
5179 /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */
5181 /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
5182 from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while
5183 processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section
5184 is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */
5185 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
5187 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
5188 Elf32_RegInfo s;
5190 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5191 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
5192 return FALSE;
5193 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
5194 elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
5197 /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
5198 set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both
5199 SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
5200 they should agree. */
5201 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
5203 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5205 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
5206 if (contents == NULL)
5207 return FALSE;
5208 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
5209 0, hdr->sh_size))
5211 free (contents);
5212 return FALSE;
5214 l = contents;
5215 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5216 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5218 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5220 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5221 &intopt);
5222 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5224 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5225 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5226 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5227 break;
5229 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5231 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
5233 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
5234 (abfd,
5235 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
5236 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5237 &intreg);
5238 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5240 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5242 Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
5244 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
5245 (abfd,
5246 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
5247 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5248 &intreg);
5249 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5251 l += intopt.size;
5253 free (contents);
5256 return TRUE;
5259 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the
5260 section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is
5261 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
5263 bfd_boolean
5264 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
5266 register const char *name;
5267 unsigned int sh_type;
5269 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
5270 sh_type = hdr->sh_type;
5272 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
5274 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
5275 hdr->sh_info = sec->size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
5276 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
5278 else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
5279 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
5280 else if (strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0)
5282 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
5283 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
5284 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
5286 else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
5287 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
5288 else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
5290 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
5291 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
5292 entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */
5293 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5294 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5295 else
5296 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5298 else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
5300 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
5301 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
5302 entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */
5303 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5305 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5306 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5307 else
5308 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5310 else
5311 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5313 else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5314 && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
5315 || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
5316 || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
5318 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5319 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5320 #if 0
5321 /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */
5322 hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
5323 #endif
5325 else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
5326 || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
5327 || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5328 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
5329 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
5330 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
5331 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5332 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
5334 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
5335 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5337 else if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content", strlen (".MIPS.content")) == 0)
5339 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
5340 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5341 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
5343 else if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5345 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
5346 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5347 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5349 else if (strncmp (name, ".debug_", sizeof ".debug_" - 1) == 0)
5350 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
5351 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
5353 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
5354 /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
5355 final_write_processing. */
5357 else if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) == 0
5358 || strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
5359 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) == 0)
5361 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
5362 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5363 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
5365 else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
5367 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
5368 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
5369 hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
5372 /* In the unlikely event a special section is empty it has to lose its
5373 special meaning. This may happen e.g. when using `strip' with the
5374 "--only-keep-debug" option. */
5375 if (sec->size > 0 && !(sec->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5376 hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
5378 /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
5379 kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the
5380 non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
5381 these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
5382 Thus we create those header only on demand now. */
5384 return TRUE;
5387 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
5388 index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
5389 Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
5390 but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
5391 the .scommon section. */
5393 bfd_boolean
5394 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5395 asection *sec, int *retval)
5397 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
5399 *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5400 return TRUE;
5402 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
5404 *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
5405 return TRUE;
5407 return FALSE;
5410 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
5411 file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */
5413 bfd_boolean
5414 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
5415 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
5416 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5417 asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
5419 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5420 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
5421 && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
5423 /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */
5424 *namep = NULL;
5425 return TRUE;
5428 /* Shared objects may have a dynamic symbol '_gp_disp' defined as
5429 a SECTION *ABS*. This causes ld to think it can resolve _gp_disp
5430 by setting a DT_NEEDED for the shared object. Since _gp_disp is
5431 a magic symbol resolved by the linker, we ignore this bogus definition
5432 of _gp_disp. New ABI objects do not suffer from this problem so this
5433 is not done for them. */
5434 if (!NEWABI_P(abfd)
5435 && (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
5436 && (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0))
5438 *namep = NULL;
5439 return TRUE;
5442 switch (sym->st_shndx)
5444 case SHN_COMMON:
5445 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5446 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */
5447 if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
5448 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
5449 break;
5450 /* Fall through. */
5451 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
5452 *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
5453 (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
5454 *valp = sym->st_size;
5455 break;
5457 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
5458 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
5459 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
5461 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
5462 asection *elf_text_section;
5463 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5465 elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5466 if (elf_text_section == NULL)
5467 return FALSE;
5469 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5470 elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5471 if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
5472 return FALSE;
5474 /* Initialize the section. */
5476 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
5477 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5479 elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5480 elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
5482 elf_text_section->name = ".text";
5483 elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5484 elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
5485 elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
5486 elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
5487 elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5488 elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
5490 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5491 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5492 so I took it out. */
5493 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
5494 break;
5496 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
5497 /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */
5498 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
5499 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
5500 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
5502 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
5503 asection *elf_data_section;
5504 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5506 elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5507 if (elf_data_section == NULL)
5508 return FALSE;
5510 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5511 elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5512 if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
5513 return FALSE;
5515 /* Initialize the section. */
5517 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
5518 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5520 elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5521 elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
5523 elf_data_section->name = ".data";
5524 elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5525 elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
5526 elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
5527 elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
5528 elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5529 elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
5531 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5532 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5533 so I took it out. */
5534 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
5535 break;
5537 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
5538 *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
5539 break;
5542 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5543 && ! info->shared
5544 && info->hash->creator == abfd->xvec
5545 && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
5547 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5548 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5550 /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */
5551 bh = NULL;
5552 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5553 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
5554 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5555 return FALSE;
5557 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5558 h->non_elf = 0;
5559 h->def_regular = 1;
5560 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
5562 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5563 return FALSE;
5565 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
5568 /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
5569 odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
5570 the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */
5571 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5572 ++*valp;
5574 return TRUE;
5577 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
5578 symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is
5579 also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */
5581 bfd_boolean
5582 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
5583 (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5584 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
5585 asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5587 /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
5588 if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
5589 common in the output file. */
5590 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
5591 && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
5592 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5594 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5595 sym->st_value &= ~1;
5597 return TRUE;
5600 /* Functions for the dynamic linker. */
5602 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */
5604 bfd_boolean
5605 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5607 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5608 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5609 flagword flags;
5610 register asection *s;
5611 const char * const *namep;
5613 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
5614 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
5616 /* Mips ABI requests the .dynamic section to be read only. */
5617 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
5618 if (s != NULL)
5620 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
5621 return FALSE;
5624 /* We need to create .got section. */
5625 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info, FALSE))
5626 return FALSE;
5628 if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, TRUE))
5629 return FALSE;
5631 /* Create .stub section. */
5632 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
5633 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == NULL)
5635 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
5636 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd),
5637 flags | SEC_CODE);
5638 if (s == NULL
5639 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5640 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5641 return FALSE;
5644 if ((IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
5645 && !info->shared
5646 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
5648 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".rld_map",
5649 flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY);
5650 if (s == NULL
5651 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5652 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5653 return FALSE;
5656 /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
5657 alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation
5658 indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
5659 the linker takes such action. */
5660 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
5662 for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
5664 bh = NULL;
5665 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5666 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
5667 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5668 return FALSE;
5670 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5671 h->non_elf = 0;
5672 h->def_regular = 1;
5673 h->type = STT_SECTION;
5675 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5676 return FALSE;
5679 /* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */
5680 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5682 if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
5683 return FALSE;
5686 /* Change alignments of some sections. */
5687 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".hash");
5688 if (s != NULL)
5689 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
5690 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
5691 if (s != NULL)
5692 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
5693 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
5694 if (s != NULL)
5695 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
5696 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
5697 if (s != NULL)
5698 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
5699 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
5700 if (s != NULL)
5701 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
5704 if (!info->shared)
5706 const char *name;
5708 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
5709 bh = NULL;
5710 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5711 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
5712 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5713 return FALSE;
5715 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5716 h->non_elf = 0;
5717 h->def_regular = 1;
5718 h->type = STT_SECTION;
5720 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5721 return FALSE;
5723 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
5725 /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
5726 and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
5727 the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
5728 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */
5729 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map");
5730 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5732 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
5733 bh = NULL;
5734 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5735 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
5736 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5737 return FALSE;
5739 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5740 h->non_elf = 0;
5741 h->def_regular = 1;
5742 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
5744 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5745 return FALSE;
5749 return TRUE;
5752 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
5753 allocate space in the global offset table. */
5755 bfd_boolean
5756 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
5757 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
5759 const char *name;
5760 bfd *dynobj;
5761 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5762 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
5763 struct mips_got_info *g;
5764 size_t extsymoff;
5765 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
5766 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
5767 asection *sgot;
5768 asection *sreloc;
5769 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
5771 if (info->relocatable)
5772 return TRUE;
5774 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
5775 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
5776 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
5777 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5779 /* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */
5781 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
5782 if (strncmp (name, FN_STUB, sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0)
5784 unsigned long r_symndx;
5786 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
5787 this is for. */
5789 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
5791 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
5792 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
5794 asection *o;
5796 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
5797 needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
5798 than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */
5799 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
5801 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
5802 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
5804 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
5805 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
5806 || o->reloc_count == 0
5807 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), FN_STUB,
5808 sizeof FN_STUB - 1) == 0
5809 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), CALL_STUB,
5810 sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
5811 || strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, o), CALL_FP_STUB,
5812 sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
5813 continue;
5815 sec_relocs
5816 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
5817 info->keep_memory);
5818 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
5819 return FALSE;
5821 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
5822 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
5823 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
5824 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) != R_MIPS16_26)
5825 break;
5827 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
5828 free (sec_relocs);
5830 if (r < rend)
5831 break;
5834 if (o == NULL)
5836 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
5837 not need it. Since this function is called before
5838 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
5839 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
5840 flag. */
5841 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5842 return TRUE;
5845 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
5846 this BFD. */
5847 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
5849 unsigned long symcount;
5850 asection **n;
5851 bfd_size_type amt;
5853 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
5854 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
5855 else
5856 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5857 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
5858 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5859 if (n == NULL)
5860 return FALSE;
5861 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
5864 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
5866 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
5867 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
5868 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
5869 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
5871 else
5873 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5875 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
5876 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
5878 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
5879 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
5880 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
5882 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
5884 h->fn_stub = sec;
5885 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
5888 else if (strncmp (name, CALL_STUB, sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) == 0
5889 || strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
5891 unsigned long r_symndx;
5892 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5893 asection **loc;
5895 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
5896 this is for. */
5898 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
5900 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
5901 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
5903 /* This stub was actually built for a static symbol defined
5904 in the same file. We assume that all static symbols in
5905 mips16 code are themselves mips16, so we can simply
5906 discard this stub. Since this function is called before
5907 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we can
5908 easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
5909 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5910 return TRUE;
5913 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
5914 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
5916 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
5918 if (strncmp (name, CALL_FP_STUB, sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) == 0)
5919 loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
5920 else
5921 loc = &h->call_stub;
5923 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
5924 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
5925 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
5926 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
5927 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. We can also discard this section if we
5928 happen to already know that this is a mips16 function; it is
5929 not necessary to check this here, as it is checked later, but
5930 it is slightly faster to check now. */
5931 if (*loc != NULL || h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
5933 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5934 return TRUE;
5937 *loc = sec;
5938 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
5941 if (dynobj == NULL)
5943 sgot = NULL;
5944 g = NULL;
5946 else
5948 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
5949 if (sgot == NULL)
5950 g = NULL;
5951 else
5953 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
5954 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
5955 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
5959 sreloc = NULL;
5960 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5961 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
5962 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
5964 unsigned long r_symndx;
5965 unsigned int r_type;
5966 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5968 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
5969 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
5971 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
5972 h = NULL;
5973 else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
5975 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5976 (_("%B: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
5977 abfd, name);
5978 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5979 return FALSE;
5981 else
5983 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
5985 /* This may be an indirect symbol created because of a version. */
5986 if (h != NULL)
5988 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5989 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
5993 /* Some relocs require a global offset table. */
5994 if (dynobj == NULL || sgot == NULL)
5996 switch (r_type)
5998 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
5999 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6000 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6001 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6002 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6003 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6004 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6005 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
6006 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6007 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6008 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6009 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6010 if (dynobj == NULL)
6011 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6012 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, FALSE))
6013 return FALSE;
6014 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6015 break;
6017 case R_MIPS_32:
6018 case R_MIPS_REL32:
6019 case R_MIPS_64:
6020 if (dynobj == NULL
6021 && (info->shared || h != NULL)
6022 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6023 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6024 break;
6026 default:
6027 break;
6031 if (!h && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
6032 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16
6033 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP))
6035 /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We
6036 don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
6037 maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
6038 the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS_GOT16 and
6039 R_MIPS_CALL16. We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
6040 R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
6041 R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */
6042 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6043 rel->r_addend, g, 0))
6044 return FALSE;
6047 switch (r_type)
6049 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6050 if (h == NULL)
6052 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6053 (_("%B: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
6054 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6055 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6056 return FALSE;
6058 /* Fall through. */
6060 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6061 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6062 if (h != NULL)
6064 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
6065 if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6066 return FALSE;
6068 /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
6069 function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See
6070 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
6071 h->needs_plt = 1;
6072 h->type = STT_FUNC;
6074 break;
6076 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6077 /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
6078 decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */
6079 if (h == NULL)
6080 break;
6081 else
6083 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6084 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6086 while (hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6087 || hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6088 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6089 hmips->root.root.u.i.link;
6091 if (hmips->root.def_regular
6092 && ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic
6093 && ! hmips->root.forced_local))
6094 break;
6096 /* Fall through. */
6098 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6099 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6100 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6101 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6102 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6103 return FALSE;
6104 break;
6106 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6107 if (info->shared)
6108 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
6109 /* Fall through */
6111 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6112 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
6114 r_symndx = 0;
6115 h = NULL;
6117 /* Fall through */
6119 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6120 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry, or two
6121 for TLS GD relocations. */
6123 unsigned char flag = (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
6124 ? GOT_TLS_GD
6125 : r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
6126 ? GOT_TLS_LDM
6127 : GOT_TLS_IE);
6128 if (h != NULL)
6130 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6131 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6132 hmips->tls_type |= flag;
6134 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, flag))
6135 return FALSE;
6137 else
6139 BFD_ASSERT (flag == GOT_TLS_LDM || r_symndx != 0);
6141 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6142 rel->r_addend, g, flag))
6143 return FALSE;
6146 break;
6148 case R_MIPS_32:
6149 case R_MIPS_REL32:
6150 case R_MIPS_64:
6151 if ((info->shared || h != NULL)
6152 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6154 if (sreloc == NULL)
6156 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, TRUE);
6157 if (sreloc == NULL)
6158 return FALSE;
6160 #define MIPS_READONLY_SECTION (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY)
6161 if (info->shared)
6163 /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
6164 reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
6165 relocs. We make room for this reloc in the
6166 .rel.dyn reloc section. */
6167 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, 1);
6168 if ((sec->flags & MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
6169 == MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
6170 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
6171 relocations against the text segment. */
6172 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6174 else
6176 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6178 /* We only need to copy this reloc if the symbol is
6179 defined in a dynamic object. */
6180 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6181 ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
6182 if ((sec->flags & MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
6183 == MIPS_READONLY_SECTION)
6184 /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
6185 are relocations against the text segment. */
6186 hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
6189 /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for
6190 this symbol, a symbol must have a dynamic symbol
6191 table index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are
6192 dynamic relocations against it. */
6193 if (h != NULL)
6195 if (dynobj == NULL)
6196 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6197 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, TRUE))
6198 return FALSE;
6199 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6200 if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6201 return FALSE;
6205 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6206 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6207 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6208 break;
6210 case R_MIPS_26:
6211 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
6212 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
6213 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
6214 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6215 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6216 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6217 break;
6219 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
6220 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
6221 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
6222 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6223 return FALSE;
6224 break;
6226 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
6227 used. Record for later use during GC. */
6228 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
6229 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6230 return FALSE;
6231 break;
6233 default:
6234 break;
6237 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
6238 related to taking the function's address. */
6239 switch (r_type)
6241 default:
6242 if (h != NULL)
6244 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
6246 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6247 mh->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
6249 break;
6250 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6251 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6252 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6253 case R_MIPS_JALR:
6254 break;
6257 /* If this reloc is not a 16 bit call, and it has a global
6258 symbol, then we will need the fn_stub if there is one.
6259 References from a stub section do not count. */
6260 if (h != NULL
6261 && r_type != R_MIPS16_26
6262 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), FN_STUB,
6263 sizeof FN_STUB - 1) != 0
6264 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), CALL_STUB,
6265 sizeof CALL_STUB - 1) != 0
6266 && strncmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), CALL_FP_STUB,
6267 sizeof CALL_FP_STUB - 1) != 0)
6269 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
6271 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6272 mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
6276 return TRUE;
6279 bfd_boolean
6280 _bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
6281 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6282 bfd_boolean *again)
6284 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6285 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
6286 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6287 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6288 size_t extsymoff;
6289 bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE;
6290 bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
6291 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6293 /* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass. */
6294 *again = FALSE;
6296 if (link_info->relocatable)
6297 return TRUE;
6299 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
6300 link_info->keep_memory);
6301 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6302 return TRUE;
6304 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count
6305 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6306 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6307 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6309 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6311 bfd_vma symval;
6312 bfd_signed_vma sym_offset;
6313 unsigned int r_type;
6314 unsigned long r_symndx;
6315 asection *sym_sec;
6316 unsigned long instruction;
6318 /* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked
6319 with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to.
6320 This saves some pipeline bubbles. */
6321 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info);
6322 if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR)
6323 continue;
6325 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info);
6326 /* Compute the address of the jump target. */
6327 if (r_symndx >= extsymoff)
6329 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h
6330 = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6331 elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6333 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6334 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6335 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
6337 /* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden,
6338 skip it. */
6339 if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6340 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6341 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
6342 || (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic
6343 && !h->root.forced_local))
6344 continue;
6346 sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
6347 if (sym_sec->output_section)
6348 symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value
6349 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6350 + sym_sec->output_offset);
6351 else
6352 symval = h->root.root.u.def.value;
6354 else
6356 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6358 /* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already. */
6359 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
6361 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6362 if (isymbuf == NULL)
6363 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
6364 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
6365 NULL, NULL, NULL);
6366 if (isymbuf == NULL)
6367 goto relax_return;
6370 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
6371 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
6372 continue;
6373 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6374 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6375 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
6376 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
6377 else
6378 sym_sec
6379 = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
6380 symval = isym->st_value
6381 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6382 + sym_sec->output_offset;
6385 /* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the
6386 branch target. */
6387 sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend)
6388 - (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4);
6390 /* Branch offset must be properly aligned. */
6391 if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0)
6392 continue;
6394 sym_offset >>= 2;
6396 /* Check that it's in range. */
6397 if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000)
6398 continue;
6400 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
6401 if (contents == NULL)
6403 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6404 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6405 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
6406 else
6408 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
6409 goto relax_return;
6413 instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
6415 /* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>. */
6416 if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809)
6417 instruction = 0x04110000;
6418 /* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>. */
6419 else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008)
6420 instruction = 0x10000000;
6421 else
6422 continue;
6424 instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff);
6425 bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset);
6426 changed_contents = TRUE;
6429 if (contents != NULL
6430 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6432 if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory)
6433 free (contents);
6434 else
6436 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6437 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6440 return TRUE;
6442 relax_return:
6443 if (contents != NULL
6444 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6445 free (contents);
6446 return FALSE;
6449 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
6450 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
6451 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
6452 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
6453 understand. */
6455 bfd_boolean
6456 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6457 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6459 bfd *dynobj;
6460 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6461 asection *s;
6463 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6465 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
6466 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
6467 && (h->needs_plt
6468 || h->u.weakdef != NULL
6469 || (h->def_dynamic
6470 && h->ref_regular
6471 && !h->def_regular)));
6473 /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, we need to copy
6474 any R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output
6475 file. */
6476 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6477 if (! info->relocatable
6478 && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
6479 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
6480 || !h->def_regular))
6482 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj,
6483 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
6484 if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
6485 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
6486 against the text segment. */
6487 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6490 /* For a function, create a stub, if allowed. */
6491 if (! hmips->no_fn_stub
6492 && h->needs_plt)
6494 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6495 return TRUE;
6497 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
6498 the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make
6499 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
6500 executable and the shared library. */
6501 if (!h->def_regular)
6503 /* We need .stub section. */
6504 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
6505 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
6506 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6508 h->root.u.def.section = s;
6509 h->root.u.def.value = s->size;
6511 /* XXX Write this stub address somewhere. */
6512 h->plt.offset = s->size;
6514 /* Make room for this stub code. */
6515 s->size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
6517 /* The last half word of the stub will be filled with the index
6518 of this symbol in .dynsym section. */
6519 return TRUE;
6522 else if ((h->type == STT_FUNC)
6523 && !h->needs_plt)
6525 /* This will set the entry for this symbol in the GOT to 0, and
6526 the dynamic linker will take care of this. */
6527 h->root.u.def.value = 0;
6528 return TRUE;
6531 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
6532 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
6533 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
6534 if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
6536 BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6537 || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
6538 h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
6539 h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
6540 return TRUE;
6543 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
6544 is not a function. */
6546 return TRUE;
6549 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
6550 and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We
6551 check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */
6553 bfd_boolean
6554 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
6555 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6557 asection *ri;
6559 bfd *dynobj;
6560 asection *s;
6561 struct mips_got_info *g;
6562 int i;
6563 bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
6564 bfd_size_type local_gotno;
6565 bfd *sub;
6566 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg count_tls_arg;
6568 /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */
6569 ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
6570 if (ri != NULL)
6571 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
6573 if (! (info->relocatable
6574 || ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen))
6575 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
6576 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs, NULL);
6578 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6579 if (dynobj == NULL)
6580 /* Relocatable links don't have it. */
6581 return TRUE;
6583 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &s);
6584 if (s == NULL)
6585 return TRUE;
6587 /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That
6588 will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
6589 required. */
6590 for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next)
6592 asection *subsection;
6594 for (subsection = sub->sections;
6595 subsection;
6596 subsection = subsection->next)
6598 if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
6599 continue;
6600 loadable_size += ((subsection->size + 0xf)
6601 &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
6605 /* There has to be a global GOT entry for every symbol with
6606 a dynamic symbol table index of DT_MIPS_GOTSYM or
6607 higher. Therefore, it make sense to put those symbols
6608 that need GOT entries at the end of the symbol table. We
6609 do that here. */
6610 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
6611 return FALSE;
6613 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
6614 i = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->global_gotsym->dynindx;
6615 else
6616 /* If there are no global symbols, or none requiring
6617 relocations, then GLOBAL_GOTSYM will be NULL. */
6618 i = 0;
6620 /* In the worst case, we'll get one stub per dynamic symbol, plus
6621 one to account for the dummy entry at the end required by IRIX
6622 rld. */
6623 loadable_size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE * (i + 1);
6625 /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of
6626 contiguous sections. Is 5 enough? */
6627 local_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
6629 g->local_gotno += local_gotno;
6630 s->size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
6632 g->global_gotno = i;
6633 s->size += i * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
6635 /* We need to calculate tls_gotno for global symbols at this point
6636 instead of building it up earlier, to avoid doublecounting
6637 entries for one global symbol from multiple input files. */
6638 count_tls_arg.info = info;
6639 count_tls_arg.needed = 0;
6640 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
6641 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries,
6642 &count_tls_arg);
6643 g->tls_gotno += count_tls_arg.needed;
6644 s->size += g->tls_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
6646 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
6648 if (s->size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (output_bfd))
6650 if (! mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, g, s, local_gotno))
6651 return FALSE;
6653 else
6655 /* Set up TLS entries for the first GOT. */
6656 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno;
6657 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
6660 return TRUE;
6663 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
6665 bfd_boolean
6666 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
6667 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6669 bfd *dynobj;
6670 asection *s;
6671 bfd_boolean reltext;
6673 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6674 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
6676 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6678 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
6679 if (info->executable)
6681 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
6682 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6683 s->size
6684 = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
6685 s->contents
6686 = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
6690 /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
6691 determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
6692 memory for them. */
6693 reltext = FALSE;
6694 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
6696 const char *name;
6698 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
6699 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
6700 name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
6702 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
6703 continue;
6705 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) == 0)
6707 if (s->size != 0)
6709 const char *outname;
6710 asection *target;
6712 /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
6713 section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
6714 If the relocation section is .rel.dyn, we always
6715 assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
6716 there exists a relocation to a read only section or
6717 not. */
6718 outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
6719 s->output_section);
6720 target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
6721 if ((target != NULL
6722 && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
6723 && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6724 || strcmp (outname, ".rel.dyn") == 0)
6725 reltext = TRUE;
6727 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
6728 to copy relocs into the output file. */
6729 if (strcmp (name, ".rel.dyn") != 0)
6730 s->reloc_count = 0;
6732 /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
6733 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
6734 and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it
6735 will move them around between input sections'
6736 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
6737 broken, so don't let it run. */
6738 info->combreloc = 0;
6741 else if (strncmp (name, ".got", 4) == 0)
6743 /* _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections() has already done
6744 most of the work, but some symbols may have been mapped
6745 to versions that we must now resolve in the got_entries
6746 hash tables. */
6747 struct mips_got_info *gg = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
6748 struct mips_got_info *g = gg;
6749 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
6750 unsigned int needed_relocs = 0;
6752 if (gg->next)
6754 set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
6755 set_got_offset_arg.info = info;
6757 /* NOTE 2005-02-03: How can this call, or the next, ever
6758 find any indirect entries to resolve? They were all
6759 resolved in mips_elf_multi_got. */
6760 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (gg);
6761 for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
6763 unsigned int save_assign;
6765 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
6767 /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries. */
6768 save_assign = g->assigned_gotno;
6769 g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno;
6770 set_got_offset_arg.g = g;
6771 set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0;
6772 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
6773 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
6774 &set_got_offset_arg);
6775 needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs;
6776 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno
6777 <= g->global_gotno);
6779 g->assigned_gotno = save_assign;
6780 if (info->shared)
6782 needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno;
6783 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
6784 + g->next->global_gotno
6785 + g->next->tls_gotno
6786 + MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO);
6790 else
6792 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg arg;
6793 arg.info = info;
6794 arg.needed = 0;
6796 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs,
6797 &arg);
6798 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
6799 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs,
6800 &arg);
6802 needed_relocs += arg.needed;
6805 if (needed_relocs)
6806 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, needed_relocs);
6808 else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)) == 0)
6810 /* IRIX rld assumes that the function stub isn't at the end
6811 of .text section. So put a dummy. XXX */
6812 s->size += MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
6814 else if (! info->shared
6815 && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
6816 && strncmp (name, ".rld_map", 8) == 0)
6818 /* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the
6819 rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */
6820 s->size += 4;
6822 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
6823 && strncmp (name, ".compact_rel", 12) == 0)
6824 s->size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
6825 else if (strncmp (name, ".init", 5) != 0)
6827 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
6828 continue;
6831 if (s->size == 0)
6833 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6834 continue;
6837 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
6838 continue;
6840 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
6841 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
6842 if (s->contents == NULL)
6844 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
6845 return FALSE;
6849 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6851 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
6852 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
6853 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
6854 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
6855 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
6856 if (! info->shared)
6858 /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
6859 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. */
6860 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
6861 return FALSE;
6862 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6864 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
6865 return FALSE;
6868 else
6870 /* Shared libraries on traditional mips have DT_DEBUG. */
6871 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6873 if (!MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
6874 return FALSE;
6878 if (reltext && SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6879 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6881 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
6883 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
6884 return FALSE;
6887 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
6888 return FALSE;
6890 if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE))
6892 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
6893 return FALSE;
6895 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
6896 return FALSE;
6898 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
6899 return FALSE;
6902 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
6903 return FALSE;
6905 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
6906 return FALSE;
6908 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
6909 return FALSE;
6911 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
6912 return FALSE;
6914 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
6915 return FALSE;
6917 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
6918 return FALSE;
6920 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
6921 return FALSE;
6923 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
6924 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
6925 return FALSE;
6927 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
6928 && (bfd_get_section_by_name
6929 (dynobj, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
6930 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
6931 return FALSE;
6934 return TRUE;
6937 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */
6939 bfd_boolean
6940 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
6941 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
6942 bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6943 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6944 asection **local_sections)
6946 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6947 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6948 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6949 bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
6950 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6952 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
6953 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6954 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
6956 const char *name;
6957 bfd_vma value = 0;
6958 reloc_howto_type *howto;
6959 bfd_boolean require_jalx;
6960 /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
6961 REL relocation. */
6962 bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
6963 unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
6964 const char *msg;
6966 /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */
6967 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
6969 /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use
6970 64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
6971 lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
6972 space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
6973 usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
6974 stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */
6975 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
6977 /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
6978 of the reloc. */
6979 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
6980 rel->r_offset += 4;
6982 else
6983 /* NewABI defaults to RELA relocations. */
6984 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type,
6985 NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
6986 && (MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P
6987 (input_bfd, input_section,
6988 rel - relocs)));
6990 if (!use_saved_addend_p)
6992 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6994 /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
6995 we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
6996 relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
6997 RELA relocation. To determine which flavor or relocation
6998 this is, we depend on the fact that the INPUT_SECTION's
6999 REL_HDR is read before its REL_HDR2. */
7000 rel_hdr = &elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr;
7001 if ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
7002 >= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel))
7003 rel_hdr = elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr2;
7004 if (rel_hdr->sh_entsize == MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (input_bfd))
7006 bfd_byte *location = contents + rel->r_offset;
7008 /* Note that this is a REL relocation. */
7009 rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
7011 /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */
7012 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7013 location);
7014 addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, input_bfd,
7015 contents);
7016 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7017 location);
7019 addend &= howto->src_mask;
7021 /* For some kinds of relocations, the ADDEND is a
7022 combination of the addend stored in two different
7023 relocations. */
7024 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16 || r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16
7025 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
7026 && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
7027 local_sections, FALSE)))
7029 bfd_vma l;
7030 const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
7031 reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
7032 bfd_byte *lo16_location;
7033 int lo16_type;
7035 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
7036 lo16_type = R_MIPS16_LO16;
7037 else
7038 lo16_type = R_MIPS_LO16;
7040 /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend,
7041 left-shifted by sixteen bits, and the LO16
7042 addend, sign extended. (Usually, the code does
7043 a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of
7044 the LO16 value.)
7046 Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation.
7048 According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16
7049 relocation must be immediately following.
7050 However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next relocation
7051 may be a composed relocation consisting of
7052 several relocations for the same address. In
7053 that case, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation may occur
7054 as one of these. We permit a similar extension
7055 in general, as that is useful for GCC. */
7056 lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (input_bfd,
7057 lo16_type,
7058 rel, relend);
7059 if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
7060 return FALSE;
7062 lo16_location = contents + lo16_relocation->r_offset;
7064 /* Obtain the addend kept there. */
7065 lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd,
7066 lo16_type, FALSE);
7067 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type, FALSE,
7068 lo16_location);
7069 l = mips_elf_obtain_contents (lo16_howto, lo16_relocation,
7070 input_bfd, contents);
7071 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type, FALSE,
7072 lo16_location);
7073 l &= lo16_howto->src_mask;
7074 l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
7075 l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
7077 addend <<= 16;
7079 /* Compute the combined addend. */
7080 addend += l;
7082 else
7083 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
7085 else
7086 addend = rel->r_addend;
7089 if (info->relocatable)
7091 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7092 unsigned long r_symndx;
7094 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
7095 && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7096 rel->r_offset -= 4;
7098 /* Since we're just relocating, all we need to do is copy
7099 the relocations back out to the object file, unless
7100 they're against a section symbol, in which case we need
7101 to adjust by the section offset, or unless they're GP
7102 relative in which case we need to adjust by the amount
7103 that we're adjusting GP in this relocatable object. */
7105 if (! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections,
7106 FALSE))
7107 /* There's nothing to do for non-local relocations. */
7108 continue;
7110 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL
7111 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL16
7112 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
7113 || r_type == R_MIPS_LITERAL)
7114 addend -= (_bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
7115 - _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd));
7117 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7118 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7119 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
7120 /* Adjust the addend appropriately. */
7121 addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
7123 if (rela_relocation_p)
7124 /* If this is a RELA relocation, just update the addend. */
7125 rel->r_addend = addend;
7126 else
7128 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
7129 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
7130 addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
7131 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
7132 addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
7133 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
7134 addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
7135 else
7136 addend >>= howto->rightshift;
7138 /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
7139 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
7140 source of the addend in the final link. */
7141 addend &= howto->src_mask;
7143 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
7144 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
7145 ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be
7146 possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
7147 but for endianness. */
7149 bfd_vma sign_bits;
7150 bfd_vma low_bits;
7151 bfd_vma high_bits;
7153 if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
7154 #ifdef BFD64
7155 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
7156 #else
7157 sign_bits = -1;
7158 #endif
7159 else
7160 sign_bits = 0;
7162 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
7163 do two separate stores. */
7164 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7166 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
7167 first. */
7168 low_bits = sign_bits;
7169 high_bits = addend;
7171 else
7173 low_bits = addend;
7174 high_bits = sign_bits;
7176 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
7177 contents + rel->r_offset);
7178 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
7179 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
7180 continue;
7183 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
7184 input_bfd, input_section,
7185 contents, FALSE))
7186 return FALSE;
7189 /* Go on to the next relocation. */
7190 continue;
7193 /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
7194 relocations for the same offset. In that case we are
7195 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
7196 for the next. */
7197 if (rel + 1 < relend
7198 && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
7199 && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
7200 use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
7201 else
7202 use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
7204 /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */
7205 switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
7206 input_section, info, rel,
7207 addend, howto, local_syms,
7208 local_sections, &value,
7209 &name, &require_jalx,
7210 use_saved_addend_p))
7212 case bfd_reloc_continue:
7213 /* There's nothing to do. */
7214 continue;
7216 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
7217 /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
7218 undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in
7219 trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
7220 just skip ahead to the next relocation. */
7221 continue;
7223 case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
7224 msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
7225 info->callbacks->warning
7226 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7227 return FALSE;
7229 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
7230 if (use_saved_addend_p)
7231 /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
7232 a given location. */
7234 else
7236 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
7237 if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
7238 (info, NULL, name, howto->name, (bfd_vma) 0,
7239 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset)))
7240 return FALSE;
7242 break;
7244 case bfd_reloc_ok:
7245 break;
7247 default:
7248 abort ();
7249 break;
7252 /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
7253 until we reach the last one. */
7254 if (use_saved_addend_p)
7256 addend = value;
7257 continue;
7260 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
7261 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
7262 ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
7263 that calculated the right value. Now, however, we
7264 sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
7265 64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we
7266 go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
7267 only a 32-bit VMA. */
7269 bfd_vma sign_bits;
7270 bfd_vma low_bits;
7271 bfd_vma high_bits;
7273 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
7274 #ifdef BFD64
7275 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
7276 #else
7277 sign_bits = -1;
7278 #endif
7279 else
7280 sign_bits = 0;
7282 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
7283 do two separate stores. */
7284 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7286 /* Undo what we did above. */
7287 rel->r_offset -= 4;
7288 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
7289 first. */
7290 low_bits = sign_bits;
7291 high_bits = value;
7293 else
7295 low_bits = value;
7296 high_bits = sign_bits;
7298 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
7299 contents + rel->r_offset);
7300 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
7301 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
7302 continue;
7305 /* Actually perform the relocation. */
7306 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
7307 input_bfd, input_section,
7308 contents, require_jalx))
7309 return FALSE;
7312 return TRUE;
7315 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
7316 adjust it appropriately now. */
7318 static void
7319 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7320 const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
7322 /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
7323 these, but we must place them into the right sections. */
7324 static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
7325 "_ftext",
7326 "_etext",
7327 "__dso_displacement",
7328 "__elf_header",
7329 "__program_header_table",
7330 NULL
7333 static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
7334 "_fdata",
7335 "_edata",
7336 "_end",
7337 "_fbss",
7338 NULL
7341 const char* const *p;
7342 int i;
7344 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
7345 for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
7347 ++p)
7348 if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
7350 /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
7351 IRIX6 linker. */
7352 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7353 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
7355 /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */
7356 if (i == 0)
7357 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
7358 else
7359 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
7361 break;
7365 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
7366 dynamic sections here. */
7368 bfd_boolean
7369 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
7370 struct bfd_link_info *info,
7371 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
7372 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
7374 bfd *dynobj;
7375 asection *sgot;
7376 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
7377 const char *name;
7379 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7381 if (h->plt.offset != MINUS_ONE)
7383 asection *s;
7384 bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE];
7386 /* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */
7388 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
7390 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
7391 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
7392 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7394 /* FIXME: Can h->dynindx be more than 64K? */
7395 if (h->dynindx & 0xffff0000)
7396 return FALSE;
7398 /* Fill the stub. */
7399 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub);
7400 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + 4);
7401 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + 8);
7402 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16 (output_bfd) + h->dynindx, stub + 12);
7404 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= s->size);
7405 memcpy (s->contents + h->plt.offset, stub, MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
7407 /* Mark the symbol as undefined. plt.offset != -1 occurs
7408 only for the referenced symbol. */
7409 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7411 /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
7412 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
7413 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */
7414 sym->st_value = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
7415 + h->plt.offset);
7418 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
7419 || h->forced_local);
7421 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7422 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
7423 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
7424 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
7425 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
7427 /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
7428 the symbols that need them. */
7429 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
7430 && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
7432 bfd_vma offset;
7433 bfd_vma value;
7435 value = sym->st_value;
7436 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h, R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
7437 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
7440 if (g->next && h->dynindx != -1 && h->type != STT_TLS)
7442 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
7443 bfd_vma entry;
7444 bfd_vma offset;
7446 gg = g;
7448 e.abfd = output_bfd;
7449 e.symndx = -1;
7450 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
7451 e.tls_type = 0;
7453 for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
7455 if (g->got_entries
7456 && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
7457 &e)))
7459 offset = p->gotidx;
7460 if (info->shared
7461 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
7462 && p->d.h != NULL
7463 && p->d.h->root.def_dynamic
7464 && !p->d.h->root.def_regular))
7466 /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to
7467 the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
7468 up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
7469 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
7470 appropriate addend. */
7471 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
7473 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
7474 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
7475 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
7476 else
7477 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
7478 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
7480 entry = 0;
7481 if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
7482 (output_bfd, info, rel,
7483 e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
7484 return FALSE;
7486 else
7487 entry = sym->st_value;
7488 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
7493 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
7494 name = h->root.root.string;
7495 if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
7496 || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
7497 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
7498 else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
7499 || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
7501 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
7502 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7503 sym->st_value = 1;
7505 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
7507 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
7508 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7509 sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
7511 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
7513 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
7514 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
7516 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7517 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
7518 sym->st_value = 0;
7519 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
7521 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
7523 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7524 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
7525 sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
7526 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
7528 else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
7530 if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
7531 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
7532 else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
7533 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
7537 /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */
7538 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
7539 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
7541 if (! info->shared)
7543 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
7544 && (strcmp (name, "__rld_map") == 0
7545 || strcmp (name, "__RLD_MAP") == 0))
7547 asection *s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map");
7548 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7549 sym->st_value = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
7550 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, s->contents);
7551 if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value == 0)
7552 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
7554 else if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
7555 && strcmp (name, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
7557 /* IRIX6 does not use a .rld_map section. */
7558 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5
7559 || IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_none)
7560 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map")
7561 != NULL);
7562 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
7566 /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */
7567 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
7568 sym->st_value &= ~1;
7570 return TRUE;
7573 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
7575 bfd_boolean
7576 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7577 struct bfd_link_info *info)
7579 bfd *dynobj;
7580 asection *sdyn;
7581 asection *sgot;
7582 struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
7584 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7586 sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
7588 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7589 if (sgot == NULL)
7590 gg = g = NULL;
7591 else
7593 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
7594 gg = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
7595 BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
7596 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd);
7597 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
7600 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7602 bfd_byte *b;
7604 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
7605 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
7607 for (b = sdyn->contents;
7608 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
7609 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
7611 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
7612 const char *name;
7613 size_t elemsize;
7614 asection *s;
7615 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
7617 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
7618 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
7620 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
7621 swap_out_p = TRUE;
7623 switch (dyn.d_tag)
7625 case DT_RELENT:
7626 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7627 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7628 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
7629 break;
7631 case DT_STRSZ:
7632 /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */
7633 dyn.d_un.d_val =
7634 _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
7635 break;
7637 case DT_PLTGOT:
7638 name = ".got";
7639 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
7640 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7641 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
7642 break;
7644 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
7645 dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
7646 break;
7648 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
7649 dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
7650 break;
7652 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
7654 time_t t;
7655 time (&t);
7656 dyn.d_un.d_val = t;
7658 break;
7660 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
7661 /* XXX FIXME: */
7662 swap_out_p = FALSE;
7663 break;
7665 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
7666 /* XXX FIXME: */
7667 swap_out_p = FALSE;
7668 break;
7670 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
7671 s = output_bfd->sections;
7672 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7673 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
7674 break;
7676 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
7677 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
7678 break;
7680 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
7681 /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
7682 entry of the first external symbol that is not
7683 referenced within the same object. */
7684 dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
7685 break;
7687 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
7688 if (gg->global_gotsym)
7690 dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
7691 break;
7693 /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
7694 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
7695 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through. */
7697 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
7698 name = ".dynsym";
7699 elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
7700 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
7701 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7703 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size / elemsize;
7704 break;
7706 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
7707 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO;
7708 break;
7710 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
7711 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value;
7712 break;
7714 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
7715 s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
7716 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
7717 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
7718 break;
7720 default:
7721 swap_out_p = FALSE;
7722 break;
7725 if (swap_out_p)
7726 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
7727 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
7731 /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
7732 runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
7733 This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */
7734 if (sgot != NULL && sgot->size > 0)
7736 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents);
7737 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000,
7738 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
7741 if (sgot != NULL)
7742 elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
7743 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7745 /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */
7746 if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
7748 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
7749 bfd_vma addend = 0;
7751 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
7752 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
7754 for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
7756 bfd_vma index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno
7757 + g->next->tls_gotno;
7759 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
7760 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
7761 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000, sgot->contents
7762 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
7764 if (! info->shared)
7765 continue;
7767 while (index < g->assigned_gotno)
7769 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
7770 = index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7771 if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
7772 (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
7773 bfd_abs_section_ptr,
7774 0, &addend, sgot)))
7775 return FALSE;
7776 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
7781 /* The generation of dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots
7782 adds more dynamic relocations. We cannot count them until
7783 here. */
7785 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7787 bfd_byte *b;
7788 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
7790 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
7792 for (b = sdyn->contents;
7793 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
7794 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
7796 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
7797 asection *s;
7799 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
7800 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
7802 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
7803 swap_out_p = TRUE;
7805 switch (dyn.d_tag)
7807 case DT_RELSZ:
7808 /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
7809 decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld,
7810 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
7811 are trailing null entries. */
7812 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7813 dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
7814 * (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
7815 ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
7816 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
7817 break;
7819 default:
7820 swap_out_p = FALSE;
7821 break;
7824 if (swap_out_p)
7825 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
7826 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
7831 asection *s;
7832 Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
7834 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
7836 /* Write .compact_rel section out. */
7837 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
7838 if (s != NULL)
7840 cpt.id1 = 1;
7841 cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
7842 cpt.id2 = 2;
7843 cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
7844 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
7845 cpt.reserved0 = 0;
7846 cpt.reserved1 = 0;
7847 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
7848 ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
7849 s->contents));
7851 /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */
7852 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
7853 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
7854 if (s != NULL)
7856 file_ptr dummy_offset;
7858 BFD_ASSERT (s->size >= MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
7859 dummy_offset = s->size - MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE;
7860 memset (s->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
7861 MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_SIZE);
7866 /* We need to sort the entries of the dynamic relocation section. */
7868 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (dynobj, FALSE);
7870 if (s != NULL
7871 && s->size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
7873 reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
7875 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
7876 qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1, s->reloc_count - 1,
7877 sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel), sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
7878 else
7879 qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1, s->reloc_count - 1,
7880 sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel), sort_dynamic_relocs);
7884 return TRUE;
7888 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */
7890 static void
7891 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
7893 flagword val;
7895 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
7897 default:
7898 case bfd_mach_mips3000:
7899 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
7900 break;
7902 case bfd_mach_mips3900:
7903 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
7904 break;
7906 case bfd_mach_mips6000:
7907 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
7908 break;
7910 case bfd_mach_mips4000:
7911 case bfd_mach_mips4300:
7912 case bfd_mach_mips4400:
7913 case bfd_mach_mips4600:
7914 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
7915 break;
7917 case bfd_mach_mips4010:
7918 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
7919 break;
7921 case bfd_mach_mips4100:
7922 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
7923 break;
7925 case bfd_mach_mips4111:
7926 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
7927 break;
7929 case bfd_mach_mips4120:
7930 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
7931 break;
7933 case bfd_mach_mips4650:
7934 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
7935 break;
7937 case bfd_mach_mips5400:
7938 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
7939 break;
7941 case bfd_mach_mips5500:
7942 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
7943 break;
7945 case bfd_mach_mips9000:
7946 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
7947 break;
7949 case bfd_mach_mips5000:
7950 case bfd_mach_mips7000:
7951 case bfd_mach_mips8000:
7952 case bfd_mach_mips10000:
7953 case bfd_mach_mips12000:
7954 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
7955 break;
7957 case bfd_mach_mips5:
7958 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
7959 break;
7961 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
7962 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
7963 break;
7965 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
7966 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
7967 break;
7969 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
7970 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
7971 break;
7973 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
7974 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
7975 break;
7977 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
7978 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
7979 break;
7981 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
7982 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
7987 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
7988 file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
7989 number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
7991 void
7992 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
7993 bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7995 unsigned int i;
7996 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
7997 const char *name;
7998 asection *sec;
8000 /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
8001 is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
8002 a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */
8003 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
8004 mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
8006 /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
8007 info for each special section. */
8008 for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
8009 i < elf_numsections (abfd);
8010 i++, hdrpp++)
8012 switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
8014 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
8015 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
8016 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
8017 if (sec != NULL)
8018 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8019 break;
8021 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
8022 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
8023 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
8024 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
8025 && strncmp (name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0);
8026 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
8027 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
8028 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8029 break;
8031 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
8032 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
8033 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
8034 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
8035 && strncmp (name, ".MIPS.content",
8036 sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1) == 0);
8037 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
8038 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
8039 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
8040 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8041 break;
8043 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
8044 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
8045 if (sec != NULL)
8046 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8047 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
8048 if (sec != NULL)
8049 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8050 break;
8052 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
8053 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
8054 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
8055 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
8056 if (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.events", sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1) == 0)
8057 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
8058 name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
8059 else
8061 BFD_ASSERT (strncmp (name, ".MIPS.post_rel",
8062 sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1) == 0);
8063 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
8064 (name
8065 + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
8067 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
8068 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
8069 break;
8075 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
8076 segments. */
8079 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd)
8081 asection *s;
8082 int ret = 0;
8084 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */
8085 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
8086 if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
8087 ++ret;
8089 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */
8090 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
8091 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
8092 MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
8093 ++ret;
8095 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */
8096 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
8097 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
8098 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
8099 ++ret;
8101 return ret;
8104 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */
8106 bfd_boolean
8107 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
8108 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8110 asection *s;
8111 struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
8112 bfd_size_type amt;
8114 /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
8115 segment. */
8116 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
8117 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
8119 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
8120 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
8121 break;
8122 if (m == NULL)
8124 amt = sizeof *m;
8125 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8126 if (m == NULL)
8127 return FALSE;
8129 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
8130 m->count = 1;
8131 m->sections[0] = s;
8133 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
8134 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
8135 while (*pm != NULL
8136 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
8137 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
8138 pm = &(*pm)->next;
8140 m->next = *pm;
8141 *pm = m;
8145 /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
8146 .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a
8147 PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
8148 table. */
8149 if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
8150 /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
8151 for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this
8152 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
8153 now. */
8154 && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
8156 for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
8157 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
8158 break;
8160 if (s)
8162 struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
8164 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
8165 while (*pm != NULL
8166 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
8167 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
8168 pm = &(*pm)->next;
8170 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
8171 options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8172 options_segment->next = *pm;
8173 options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
8174 options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
8175 options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
8176 options_segment->count = 1;
8177 options_segment->sections[0] = s;
8178 *pm = options_segment;
8181 else
8183 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
8185 /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
8186 for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */
8187 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
8188 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
8189 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
8191 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
8192 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
8193 break;
8194 if (m == NULL)
8196 amt = sizeof *m;
8197 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8198 if (m == NULL)
8199 return FALSE;
8201 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
8203 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
8204 if (s == NULL)
8206 m->count = 0;
8207 m->p_flags = 0;
8208 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
8210 else
8212 m->count = 1;
8213 m->sections[0] = s;
8216 /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */
8217 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
8218 while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
8219 pm = &(*pm)->next;
8220 if (*pm != NULL)
8221 pm = &(*pm)->next;
8223 m->next = *pm;
8224 *pm = m;
8228 /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
8229 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
8230 between. */
8231 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL;
8232 pm = &(*pm)->next)
8233 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
8234 break;
8235 m = *pm;
8236 if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
8238 /* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC
8239 segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since
8240 the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters
8241 sometimes for the dynamic linker. */
8242 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
8244 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X;
8245 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
8248 if (m != NULL
8249 && m->count == 1 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
8251 static const char *sec_names[] =
8253 ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
8255 bfd_vma low, high;
8256 unsigned int i, c;
8257 struct elf_segment_map *n;
8259 low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
8260 high = 0;
8261 for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
8263 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
8264 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
8266 bfd_size_type sz;
8268 if (low > s->vma)
8269 low = s->vma;
8270 sz = s->size;
8271 if (high < s->vma + sz)
8272 high = s->vma + sz;
8276 c = 0;
8277 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8278 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
8279 && s->vma >= low
8280 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
8281 ++c;
8283 amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
8284 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8285 if (n == NULL)
8286 return FALSE;
8287 *n = *m;
8288 n->count = c;
8290 i = 0;
8291 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8293 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
8294 && s->vma >= low
8295 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
8297 n->sections[i] = s;
8298 ++i;
8302 *pm = n;
8306 return TRUE;
8309 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
8310 relocation. */
8312 asection *
8313 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
8314 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8315 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
8316 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8317 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8319 /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */
8321 if (h != NULL)
8323 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
8325 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
8326 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
8327 break;
8329 default:
8330 switch (h->root.type)
8332 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
8333 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
8334 return h->root.u.def.section;
8336 case bfd_link_hash_common:
8337 return h->root.u.c.p->section;
8339 default:
8340 break;
8344 else
8345 return bfd_section_from_elf_index (sec->owner, sym->st_shndx);
8347 return NULL;
8350 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */
8352 bfd_boolean
8353 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8354 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8355 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8356 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8358 #if 0
8359 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8360 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
8361 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
8362 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
8363 unsigned long r_symndx;
8364 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8366 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8367 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
8368 local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
8370 relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
8371 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
8372 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
8374 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
8375 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
8376 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
8377 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
8378 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
8379 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
8380 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
8381 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8382 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
8383 /* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
8384 of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
8385 so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time. */
8386 break;
8388 default:
8389 break;
8391 #endif
8393 return TRUE;
8396 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
8397 hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation
8398 information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
8399 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */
8401 void
8402 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
8403 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
8404 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
8406 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
8408 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
8410 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
8411 return;
8413 dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
8414 indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
8415 dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
8416 if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
8417 dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
8418 if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
8419 dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
8421 if (dirmips->tls_type == 0)
8422 dirmips->tls_type = indmips->tls_type;
8425 void
8426 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
8427 struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry,
8428 bfd_boolean force_local)
8430 bfd *dynobj;
8431 asection *got;
8432 struct mips_got_info *g;
8433 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8435 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
8436 if (h->forced_local)
8437 return;
8438 h->forced_local = force_local;
8440 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8441 if (dynobj != NULL && force_local && h->root.type != STT_TLS
8442 && (got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE)) != NULL
8443 && (g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info) != NULL)
8445 if (g->next)
8447 struct mips_got_entry e;
8448 struct mips_got_info *gg = g;
8450 /* Since we're turning what used to be a global symbol into a
8451 local one, bump up the number of local entries of each GOT
8452 that had an entry for it. This will automatically decrease
8453 the number of global entries, since global_gotno is actually
8454 the upper limit of global entries. */
8455 e.abfd = dynobj;
8456 e.symndx = -1;
8457 e.d.h = h;
8458 e.tls_type = 0;
8460 for (g = g->next; g != gg; g = g->next)
8461 if (htab_find (g->got_entries, &e))
8463 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
8464 g->local_gotno++;
8465 g->global_gotno--;
8468 /* If this was a global symbol forced into the primary GOT, we
8469 no longer need an entry for it. We can't release the entry
8470 at this point, but we must at least stop counting it as one
8471 of the symbols that required a forced got entry. */
8472 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
8474 BFD_ASSERT (gg->assigned_gotno > 0);
8475 gg->assigned_gotno--;
8478 else if (g->global_gotno == 0 && g->global_gotsym == NULL)
8479 /* If we haven't got through GOT allocation yet, just bump up the
8480 number of local entries, as this symbol won't be counted as
8481 global. */
8482 g->local_gotno++;
8483 else if (h->root.got.offset == 1)
8485 /* If we're past non-multi-GOT allocation and this symbol had
8486 been marked for a global got entry, give it a local entry
8487 instead. */
8488 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
8489 g->local_gotno++;
8490 g->global_gotno--;
8494 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->root, force_local);
8497 #define PDR_SIZE 32
8499 bfd_boolean
8500 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
8501 struct bfd_link_info *info)
8503 asection *o;
8504 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8505 unsigned char *tdata;
8506 size_t i, skip;
8508 o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
8509 if (! o)
8510 return FALSE;
8511 if (o->size == 0)
8512 return FALSE;
8513 if (o->size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
8514 return FALSE;
8515 if (o->output_section != NULL
8516 && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
8517 return FALSE;
8519 tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->size / PDR_SIZE);
8520 if (! tdata)
8521 return FALSE;
8523 cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
8524 info->keep_memory);
8525 if (!cookie->rels)
8527 free (tdata);
8528 return FALSE;
8531 cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
8532 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
8534 for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
8536 if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
8538 tdata[i] = 1;
8539 skip ++;
8543 if (skip != 0)
8545 mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
8546 o->size -= skip * PDR_SIZE;
8547 ret = TRUE;
8549 else
8550 free (tdata);
8552 if (! info->keep_memory)
8553 free (cookie->rels);
8555 return ret;
8558 bfd_boolean
8559 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
8561 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
8562 return TRUE;
8563 return FALSE;
8566 bfd_boolean
8567 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd, asection *sec,
8568 bfd_byte *contents)
8570 bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
8571 int i;
8573 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
8574 return FALSE;
8576 if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
8577 return FALSE;
8579 to = contents;
8580 end = contents + sec->size;
8581 for (from = contents, i = 0;
8582 from < end;
8583 from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
8585 if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
8586 continue;
8587 if (to != from)
8588 memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
8589 to += PDR_SIZE;
8591 bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
8592 sec->output_offset, sec->size);
8593 return TRUE;
8596 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
8597 handle the ECOFF debugging information. */
8599 struct mips_elf_find_line
8601 struct ecoff_debug_info d;
8602 struct ecoff_find_line i;
8605 bfd_boolean
8606 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
8607 asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset,
8608 const char **filename_ptr,
8609 const char **functionname_ptr,
8610 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8612 asection *msec;
8614 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
8615 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8616 line_ptr))
8617 return TRUE;
8619 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
8620 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8621 line_ptr, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
8622 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
8623 return TRUE;
8625 msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
8626 if (msec != NULL)
8628 flagword origflags;
8629 struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
8630 const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
8631 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
8633 /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
8634 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here
8635 if appropriate (which it normally will be). */
8636 origflags = msec->flags;
8637 if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
8638 msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
8640 fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
8641 if (fi == NULL)
8643 bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
8644 char *fraw_src;
8645 char *fraw_end;
8646 struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
8647 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
8649 fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8650 if (fi == NULL)
8652 msec->flags = origflags;
8653 return FALSE;
8656 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
8658 msec->flags = origflags;
8659 return FALSE;
8662 /* Swap in the FDR information. */
8663 amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
8664 fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8665 if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
8667 msec->flags = origflags;
8668 return FALSE;
8670 external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
8671 fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
8672 fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
8673 fraw_end = (fraw_src
8674 + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
8675 for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
8676 (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
8678 elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
8680 /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
8681 find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
8682 objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
8683 rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
8684 wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a
8685 good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */
8688 if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
8689 &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8690 line_ptr))
8692 msec->flags = origflags;
8693 return TRUE;
8696 msec->flags = origflags;
8699 /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */
8701 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
8702 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8703 line_ptr);
8706 bfd_boolean
8707 _bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8708 const char **filename_ptr,
8709 const char **functionname_ptr,
8710 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8712 bfd_boolean found;
8713 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8714 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8715 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8716 return found;
8720 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
8721 remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
8722 GP value in the section_processing routine. */
8724 bfd_boolean
8725 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
8726 const void *location,
8727 file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
8729 if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (section->name))
8731 bfd_byte *c;
8733 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
8735 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
8736 section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8737 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
8738 return FALSE;
8740 c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
8741 if (c == NULL)
8743 c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, section->size);
8744 if (c == NULL)
8745 return FALSE;
8746 mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
8749 memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
8752 return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
8753 count);
8756 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
8757 MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */
8759 bfd_byte *
8760 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
8761 (bfd *abfd,
8762 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
8763 struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
8764 bfd_byte *data,
8765 bfd_boolean relocatable,
8766 asymbol **symbols)
8768 /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
8769 bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
8770 asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
8771 bfd_size_type sz;
8773 long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
8774 arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
8775 long reloc_count;
8777 if (reloc_size < 0)
8778 goto error_return;
8780 reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
8781 if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
8782 goto error_return;
8784 /* read in the section */
8785 sz = input_section->rawsize ? input_section->rawsize : input_section->size;
8786 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, sz))
8787 goto error_return;
8789 reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
8790 input_section,
8791 reloc_vector,
8792 symbols);
8793 if (reloc_count < 0)
8794 goto error_return;
8796 if (reloc_count > 0)
8798 arelent **parent;
8799 /* for mips */
8800 int gp_found;
8801 bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */
8804 struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
8805 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
8806 /* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */
8807 if (abfd && input_bfd
8808 && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
8809 lh = 0;
8810 else
8812 h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
8813 lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
8815 lookup:
8816 if (lh)
8818 switch (lh->type)
8820 case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
8821 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
8822 case bfd_link_hash_common:
8823 gp_found = 0;
8824 break;
8825 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
8826 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
8827 gp_found = 1;
8828 gp = lh->u.def.value;
8829 break;
8830 case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
8831 case bfd_link_hash_warning:
8832 lh = lh->u.i.link;
8833 /* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */
8834 goto lookup;
8835 case bfd_link_hash_new:
8836 default:
8837 abort ();
8840 else
8841 gp_found = 0;
8843 /* end mips */
8844 for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
8846 char *error_message = NULL;
8847 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
8849 /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
8850 knowing the gp of the output bfd. */
8851 asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
8853 /* If we've managed to find the gp and have a special
8854 function for the relocation then go ahead, else default
8855 to the generic handling. */
8856 if (gp_found
8857 && (*parent)->howto->special_function
8858 == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
8859 r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
8860 input_section, relocatable,
8861 data, gp);
8862 else
8863 r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data,
8864 input_section,
8865 relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
8866 &error_message);
8868 if (relocatable)
8870 asection *os = input_section->output_section;
8872 /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
8873 os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
8874 os->reloc_count++;
8877 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
8879 switch (r)
8881 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
8882 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
8883 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
8884 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address, TRUE)))
8885 goto error_return;
8886 break;
8887 case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
8888 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
8889 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
8890 (link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
8891 (*parent)->address)))
8892 goto error_return;
8893 break;
8894 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
8895 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
8896 (link_info, NULL,
8897 bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
8898 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
8899 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address)))
8900 goto error_return;
8901 break;
8902 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
8903 default:
8904 abort ();
8905 break;
8911 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
8912 free (reloc_vector);
8913 return data;
8915 error_return:
8916 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
8917 free (reloc_vector);
8918 return NULL;
8921 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
8923 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
8924 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
8926 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
8927 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
8929 ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
8930 if (ret == NULL)
8931 return NULL;
8933 if (! _bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
8934 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc))
8936 free (ret);
8937 return NULL;
8940 #if 0
8941 /* We no longer use this. */
8942 for (i = 0; i < SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; i++)
8943 ret->dynsym_sec_strindex[i] = (bfd_size_type) -1;
8944 #endif
8945 ret->procedure_count = 0;
8946 ret->compact_rel_size = 0;
8947 ret->use_rld_obj_head = FALSE;
8948 ret->rld_value = 0;
8949 ret->mips16_stubs_seen = FALSE;
8951 return &ret->root.root;
8954 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
8955 the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these
8956 sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */
8958 bfd_boolean
8959 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8961 asection *o;
8962 struct bfd_link_order *p;
8963 asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
8964 asection *rtproc_sec;
8965 Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
8966 struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
8967 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8968 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap = bed->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
8969 HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
8970 void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
8971 asection *s;
8972 EXTR esym;
8973 unsigned int i;
8974 bfd_size_type amt;
8976 static const char * const secname[] =
8978 ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
8979 ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
8981 static const int sc[] =
8983 scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
8984 scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
8987 /* We'd carefully arranged the dynamic symbol indices, and then the
8988 generic size_dynamic_sections renumbered them out from under us.
8989 Rather than trying somehow to prevent the renumbering, just do
8990 the sort again. */
8991 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8993 bfd *dynobj;
8994 asection *got;
8995 struct mips_got_info *g;
8996 bfd_size_type dynsecsymcount;
8998 /* When we resort, we must tell mips_elf_sort_hash_table what
8999 the lowest index it may use is. That's the number of section
9000 symbols we're going to add. The generic ELF linker only
9001 adds these symbols when building a shared object. Note that
9002 we count the sections after (possibly) removing the .options
9003 section above. */
9005 dynsecsymcount = 0;
9006 if (info->shared)
9008 asection * p;
9010 for (p = abfd->sections; p ; p = p->next)
9011 if ((p->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
9012 && (p->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
9013 && !(*bed->elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym) (abfd, info, p))
9014 ++ dynsecsymcount;
9017 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, dynsecsymcount + 1))
9018 return FALSE;
9020 /* Make sure we didn't grow the global .got region. */
9021 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9022 got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
9023 g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info;
9025 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
9026 BFD_ASSERT ((elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
9027 - g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
9028 <= g->global_gotno);
9031 /* Get a value for the GP register. */
9032 if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
9034 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
9036 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
9037 if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
9038 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
9039 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
9040 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
9041 else if (info->relocatable)
9043 bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
9045 /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */
9046 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
9047 if (o->vma < lo
9048 && (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
9049 lo = o->vma;
9051 /* And calculate GP relative to that. */
9052 elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (abfd);
9054 else
9056 /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
9057 involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
9058 callback to warn that GP is not defined. */
9062 /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
9063 information. */
9064 reginfo_sec = NULL;
9065 mdebug_sec = NULL;
9066 gptab_data_sec = NULL;
9067 gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
9068 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
9070 if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
9072 memset (&reginfo, 0, sizeof reginfo);
9074 /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
9075 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
9076 the information together. */
9077 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9079 asection *input_section;
9080 bfd *input_bfd;
9081 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
9082 Elf32_RegInfo sub;
9084 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
9086 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
9087 continue;
9088 abort ();
9091 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
9092 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
9094 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
9095 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
9096 return FALSE;
9098 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
9100 reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
9101 reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
9102 reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
9103 reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
9104 reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
9106 /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
9107 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
9108 finally written out. */
9110 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
9111 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
9112 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9115 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
9116 BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
9118 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
9119 matters, but someday it might). */
9120 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
9122 reginfo_sec = o;
9125 if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
9127 struct extsym_info einfo;
9128 bfd_vma last;
9130 /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
9131 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
9132 the information together. */
9133 symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
9134 /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */
9135 symhdr->vstamp = 0;
9136 symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
9137 symhdr->cbLine = 0;
9138 symhdr->idnMax = 0;
9139 symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
9140 symhdr->isymMax = 0;
9141 symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
9142 symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
9143 symhdr->issMax = 0;
9144 symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
9145 symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
9146 symhdr->crfd = 0;
9147 symhdr->iextMax = 0;
9149 /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
9150 debug_info structure. */
9151 debug.line = NULL;
9152 debug.external_dnr = NULL;
9153 debug.external_pdr = NULL;
9154 debug.external_sym = NULL;
9155 debug.external_opt = NULL;
9156 debug.external_aux = NULL;
9157 debug.ss = NULL;
9158 debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
9159 debug.external_fdr = NULL;
9160 debug.external_rfd = NULL;
9161 debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
9163 mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
9164 if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
9165 return FALSE;
9167 esym.jmptbl = 0;
9168 esym.cobol_main = 0;
9169 esym.weakext = 0;
9170 esym.reserved = 0;
9171 esym.ifd = ifdNil;
9172 esym.asym.iss = issNil;
9173 esym.asym.st = stLocal;
9174 esym.asym.reserved = 0;
9175 esym.asym.index = indexNil;
9176 last = 0;
9177 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
9179 esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
9180 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
9181 if (s != NULL)
9183 esym.asym.value = s->vma;
9184 last = s->vma + s->size;
9186 else
9187 esym.asym.value = last;
9188 if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
9189 secname[i], &esym))
9190 return FALSE;
9193 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9195 asection *input_section;
9196 bfd *input_bfd;
9197 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
9198 struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
9199 char *eraw_src;
9200 char *eraw_end;
9202 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
9204 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
9205 continue;
9206 abort ();
9209 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
9210 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
9212 if (bfd_get_flavour (input_bfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
9213 || (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
9214 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap) == NULL)
9216 /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
9217 doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
9218 want to deal with it. */
9219 continue;
9222 input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
9223 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
9225 BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->size);
9227 /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
9228 read in the debugging information and set up an
9229 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */
9230 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
9231 &input_debug))
9232 return FALSE;
9234 if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
9235 (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
9236 &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
9237 return FALSE;
9239 /* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with
9240 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
9241 the linker global hash table and save the information
9242 for the output external symbols. */
9243 eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
9244 eraw_end = (eraw_src
9245 + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
9246 * input_swap->external_ext_size));
9247 for (;
9248 eraw_src < eraw_end;
9249 eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
9251 EXTR ext;
9252 const char *name;
9253 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9255 (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
9256 if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
9257 || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
9258 || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
9259 continue;
9261 name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
9262 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
9263 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
9264 if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
9265 continue;
9267 if (ext.ifd != -1)
9269 BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
9270 < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
9271 ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
9274 h->esym = ext;
9277 /* Free up the information we just read. */
9278 free (input_debug.line);
9279 free (input_debug.external_dnr);
9280 free (input_debug.external_pdr);
9281 free (input_debug.external_sym);
9282 free (input_debug.external_opt);
9283 free (input_debug.external_aux);
9284 free (input_debug.ss);
9285 free (input_debug.ssext);
9286 free (input_debug.external_fdr);
9287 free (input_debug.external_rfd);
9288 free (input_debug.external_ext);
9290 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
9291 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
9292 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9295 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared)
9297 /* Create .rtproc section. */
9298 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
9299 if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
9301 flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
9302 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
9304 rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
9305 ".rtproc",
9306 flags);
9307 if (rtproc_sec == NULL
9308 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
9309 return FALSE;
9312 if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
9313 info, rtproc_sec,
9314 &debug))
9315 return FALSE;
9318 /* Build the external symbol information. */
9319 einfo.abfd = abfd;
9320 einfo.info = info;
9321 einfo.debug = &debug;
9322 einfo.swap = swap;
9323 einfo.failed = FALSE;
9324 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
9325 mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
9326 if (einfo.failed)
9327 return FALSE;
9329 /* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */
9330 o->size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
9332 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
9333 matters, but someday it might). */
9334 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
9336 mdebug_sec = o;
9339 if (strncmp (o->name, ".gptab.", sizeof ".gptab." - 1) == 0)
9341 const char *subname;
9342 unsigned int c;
9343 Elf32_gptab *tab;
9344 Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
9345 unsigned int j;
9347 /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
9348 information describing how the small data area would
9349 change depending upon the -G switch. These sections
9350 not used in executables files. */
9351 if (! info->relocatable)
9353 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9355 asection *input_section;
9357 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
9359 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
9360 continue;
9361 abort ();
9364 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
9366 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
9367 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
9368 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9371 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
9372 currently matters, but someday it might). */
9373 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
9375 /* Really remove the section. */
9376 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, o);
9377 --abfd->section_count;
9379 continue;
9382 /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
9383 uninitialized data. */
9384 if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
9385 gptab_data_sec = o;
9386 else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
9387 gptab_bss_sec = o;
9388 else
9390 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9391 (_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
9392 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
9393 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
9394 return FALSE;
9397 /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
9398 .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
9399 .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is
9400 no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
9401 case we must change the name of the output section. */
9402 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
9403 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
9405 if (o == gptab_data_sec)
9406 o->name = ".gptab.data";
9407 else
9408 o->name = ".gptab.bss";
9409 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
9410 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
9413 /* Set up the first entry. */
9414 c = 1;
9415 amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
9416 tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
9417 if (tab == NULL)
9418 return FALSE;
9419 tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
9420 tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
9422 /* Combine the input sections. */
9423 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
9425 asection *input_section;
9426 bfd *input_bfd;
9427 bfd_size_type size;
9428 unsigned long last;
9429 bfd_size_type gpentry;
9431 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
9433 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
9434 continue;
9435 abort ();
9438 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
9439 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
9441 /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
9442 by one. We know that the input gptab entries are
9443 sorted by ascending -G value. */
9444 size = input_section->size;
9445 last = 0;
9446 for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
9447 gpentry < size;
9448 gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
9450 Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
9451 Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
9452 unsigned long val;
9453 unsigned long add;
9454 bfd_boolean exact;
9455 unsigned int look;
9457 if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
9458 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
9459 sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
9461 free (tab);
9462 return FALSE;
9465 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
9466 &int_gptab);
9467 val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
9468 add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
9470 exact = FALSE;
9471 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
9473 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
9474 tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
9476 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
9477 exact = TRUE;
9480 if (! exact)
9482 Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
9483 unsigned int max;
9485 /* We need a new table entry. */
9486 amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
9487 new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
9488 if (new_tab == NULL)
9490 free (tab);
9491 return FALSE;
9493 tab = new_tab;
9494 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
9495 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
9497 /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
9498 value, since that will be implied by this new
9499 value. */
9500 max = 0;
9501 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
9503 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
9504 && (max == 0
9505 || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
9506 > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
9507 max = look;
9509 if (max != 0)
9510 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
9511 tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
9513 ++c;
9516 last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
9519 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
9520 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
9521 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9524 /* The table must be sorted by -G value. */
9525 if (c > 2)
9526 qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
9528 /* Swap out the table. */
9529 amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
9530 ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
9531 if (ext_tab == NULL)
9533 free (tab);
9534 return FALSE;
9537 for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
9538 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
9539 free (tab);
9541 o->size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
9542 o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
9544 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
9545 matters, but someday it might). */
9546 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
9550 /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
9551 if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
9552 return FALSE;
9554 /* Now write out the computed sections. */
9556 if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
9558 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
9560 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, &reginfo, &ext);
9561 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
9562 return FALSE;
9565 if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
9567 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
9568 if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
9569 swap, info,
9570 mdebug_sec->filepos))
9571 return FALSE;
9573 bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
9576 if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
9578 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
9579 gptab_data_sec->contents,
9580 0, gptab_data_sec->size))
9581 return FALSE;
9584 if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
9586 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
9587 gptab_bss_sec->contents,
9588 0, gptab_bss_sec->size))
9589 return FALSE;
9592 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
9594 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
9595 if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
9597 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
9598 rtproc_sec->contents,
9599 0, rtproc_sec->size))
9600 return FALSE;
9604 return TRUE;
9607 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */
9609 struct mips_mach_extension {
9610 unsigned long extension, base;
9614 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries
9615 are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */
9617 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = {
9618 /* MIPS64 extensions. */
9619 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
9620 { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
9622 /* MIPS V extensions. */
9623 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
9625 /* R10000 extensions. */
9626 { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
9628 /* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
9629 vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems
9630 better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
9631 many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add
9632 some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */
9633 { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
9634 { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
9636 /* MIPS IV extensions. */
9637 { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
9638 { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
9639 { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
9640 { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
9641 { bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
9643 /* VR4100 extensions. */
9644 { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
9645 { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
9647 /* MIPS III extensions. */
9648 { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9649 { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9650 { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9651 { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9652 { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9653 { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9654 { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
9656 /* MIPS32 extensions. */
9657 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
9659 /* MIPS II extensions. */
9660 { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
9661 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
9663 /* MIPS I extensions. */
9664 { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
9665 { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
9669 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */
9671 static bfd_boolean
9672 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
9674 size_t i;
9676 if (extension == base)
9677 return TRUE;
9679 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
9680 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
9681 return TRUE;
9683 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
9684 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
9685 return TRUE;
9687 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
9688 if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
9690 extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
9691 if (extension == base)
9692 return TRUE;
9695 return FALSE;
9699 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */
9701 static bfd_boolean
9702 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
9704 return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
9705 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
9706 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
9707 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
9708 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
9709 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
9710 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
9714 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
9715 object file when linking. */
9717 bfd_boolean
9718 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
9720 flagword old_flags;
9721 flagword new_flags;
9722 bfd_boolean ok;
9723 bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
9724 asection *sec;
9726 /* Check if we have the same endianess */
9727 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
9729 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9730 (_("%B: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
9731 ibfd);
9732 return FALSE;
9735 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
9736 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
9737 return TRUE;
9739 if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
9741 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9742 (_("%B: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
9743 ibfd);
9744 return FALSE;
9747 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
9748 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
9749 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
9751 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
9753 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
9754 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
9755 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
9756 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
9758 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
9759 && bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default)
9761 if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
9762 bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
9763 return FALSE;
9766 return TRUE;
9769 /* Check flag compatibility. */
9771 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
9772 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
9774 /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It
9775 doesn't seem to matter. */
9776 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
9777 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
9779 /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should
9780 just be able to ignore this. */
9781 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
9782 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
9784 if (new_flags == old_flags)
9785 return TRUE;
9787 /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections.
9788 If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot
9789 actually cause any incompatibility. */
9790 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
9792 /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
9793 which are automatically generated by gas. */
9794 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
9795 && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
9796 && (sec->size != 0
9797 || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
9798 && strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
9799 && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
9801 null_input_bfd = FALSE;
9802 break;
9805 if (null_input_bfd)
9806 return TRUE;
9808 ok = TRUE;
9810 if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
9811 != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
9813 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9814 (_("%B: warning: linking PIC files with non-PIC files"),
9815 ibfd);
9816 ok = TRUE;
9819 if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
9820 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
9821 if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
9822 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
9824 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
9825 old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
9827 /* Compare the ISAs. */
9828 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
9830 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9831 (_("%B: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
9832 ibfd);
9833 ok = FALSE;
9835 else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
9837 /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */
9838 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
9840 /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy
9841 the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
9842 OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */
9843 bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
9844 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
9845 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
9846 |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
9848 /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
9849 and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */
9850 if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
9851 && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
9852 && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
9853 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
9855 else
9857 /* The ISAs aren't compatible. */
9858 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9859 (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
9860 ibfd,
9861 bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
9862 bfd_printable_name (obfd));
9863 ok = FALSE;
9867 new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
9868 old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
9870 /* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it
9871 does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */
9872 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
9873 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
9874 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
9876 /* Only error if both are set (to different values). */
9877 if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
9878 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
9879 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
9881 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9882 (_("%B: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
9883 ibfd,
9884 elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
9885 elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
9886 ok = FALSE;
9888 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
9889 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
9892 /* For now, allow arbitrary mixing of ASEs (retain the union). */
9893 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
9895 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
9897 new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
9898 old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
9901 /* Warn about any other mismatches */
9902 if (new_flags != old_flags)
9904 (*_bfd_error_handler)
9905 (_("%B: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"),
9906 ibfd, (unsigned long) new_flags,
9907 (unsigned long) old_flags);
9908 ok = FALSE;
9911 if (! ok)
9913 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9914 return FALSE;
9917 return TRUE;
9920 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */
9922 bfd_boolean
9923 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
9925 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
9926 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
9928 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
9929 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
9930 return TRUE;
9933 bfd_boolean
9934 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
9936 FILE *file = ptr;
9938 BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
9940 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
9941 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
9943 /* xgettext:c-format */
9944 fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
9946 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
9947 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
9948 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
9949 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
9950 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
9951 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
9952 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
9953 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
9954 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
9955 fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
9956 else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
9957 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
9958 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
9959 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
9960 else
9961 fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
9963 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
9964 fprintf (file, _(" [mips1]"));
9965 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
9966 fprintf (file, _(" [mips2]"));
9967 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
9968 fprintf (file, _(" [mips3]"));
9969 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
9970 fprintf (file, _(" [mips4]"));
9971 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
9972 fprintf (file, _(" [mips5]"));
9973 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
9974 fprintf (file, _(" [mips32]"));
9975 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
9976 fprintf (file, _(" [mips64]"));
9977 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
9978 fprintf (file, _(" [mips32r2]"));
9979 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
9980 fprintf (file, _(" [mips64r2]"));
9981 else
9982 fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
9984 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
9985 fprintf (file, _(" [mdmx]"));
9987 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
9988 fprintf (file, _(" [mips16]"));
9990 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
9991 fprintf (file, _(" [32bitmode]"));
9992 else
9993 fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
9995 fputc ('\n', file);
9997 return TRUE;
10000 const struct bfd_elf_special_section _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[] =
10002 { ".lit4", 5, 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
10003 { ".lit8", 5, 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
10004 { ".mdebug", 7, 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
10005 { ".sbss", 5, -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
10006 { ".sdata", 6, -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
10007 { ".ucode", 6, 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
10008 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
10011 /* Ensure that the STO_OPTIONAL flag is copied into h->other,
10012 even if this is not a defintion of the symbol. */
10013 void
10014 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
10015 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
10016 bfd_boolean definition,
10017 bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10019 if (! definition
10020 && ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (isym->st_other))
10021 h->other |= STO_OPTIONAL;
10024 /* Decide whether an undefined symbol is special and can be ignored.
10025 This is the case for OPTIONAL symbols on IRIX. */
10026 bfd_boolean
10027 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
10029 return ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->other) ? TRUE : FALSE;